Don't make dynamic .data.rel.ro SEC_READONLY
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1993-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3
4 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
5 <ian@cygnus.com>.
6 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
7 <mark@codesourcery.com>
8 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
9 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
10
11 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
12
13 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
14 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
15 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
16 (at your option) any later version.
17
18 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
19 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
20 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
21 GNU General Public License for more details.
22
23 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
24 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
25 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
26 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27
28
29 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
30
31 #include "sysdep.h"
32 #include "bfd.h"
33 #include "libbfd.h"
34 #include "libiberty.h"
35 #include "elf-bfd.h"
36 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
37 #include "elf/mips.h"
38 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
39 #include "dwarf2.h"
40
41 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
42 #include "coff/sym.h"
43 #include "coff/symconst.h"
44 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
45 #include "coff/mips.h"
46
47 #include "hashtab.h"
48
49 /* Types of TLS GOT entry. */
50 enum mips_got_tls_type {
51 GOT_TLS_NONE,
52 GOT_TLS_GD,
53 GOT_TLS_LDM,
54 GOT_TLS_IE
55 };
56
57 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
58 There are four types of entry:
59
60 (1) an absolute address
61 requires: abfd == NULL
62 fields: d.address
63
64 (2) a SYMBOL + OFFSET address, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
65 requires: abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0, tls_type != GOT_TLS_LDM
66 fields: abfd, symndx, d.addend, tls_type
67
68 (3) a SYMBOL address, where SYMBOL is not local to an input bfd
69 requires: abfd != NULL, symndx == -1
70 fields: d.h, tls_type
71
72 (4) a TLS LDM slot
73 requires: abfd != NULL, symndx == 0, tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM
74 fields: none; there's only one of these per GOT. */
75 struct mips_got_entry
76 {
77 /* One input bfd that needs the GOT entry. */
78 bfd *abfd;
79 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
80 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
81 long symndx;
82 union
83 {
84 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
85 bfd_vma address;
86 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
87 that should be added to the symbol value. */
88 bfd_vma addend;
89 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
90 corresponding to a symbol in the GOT. The symbol's entry
91 is in the local area if h->global_got_area is GGA_NONE,
92 otherwise it is in the global area. */
93 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
94 } d;
95
96 /* The TLS type of this GOT entry. An LDM GOT entry will be a local
97 symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
98 unsigned char tls_type;
99
100 /* True if we have filled in the GOT contents for a TLS entry,
101 and created the associated relocations. */
102 unsigned char tls_initialized;
103
104 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
105 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
106 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
107 long gotidx;
108 };
109
110 /* This structure represents a GOT page reference from an input bfd.
111 Each instance represents a symbol + ADDEND, where the representation
112 of the symbol depends on whether it is local to the input bfd.
113 If it is, then SYMNDX >= 0, and the symbol has index SYMNDX in U.ABFD.
114 Otherwise, SYMNDX < 0 and U.H points to the symbol's hash table entry.
115
116 Page references with SYMNDX >= 0 always become page references
117 in the output. Page references with SYMNDX < 0 only become page
118 references if the symbol binds locally; in other cases, the page
119 reference decays to a global GOT reference. */
120 struct mips_got_page_ref
121 {
122 long symndx;
123 union
124 {
125 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
126 bfd *abfd;
127 } u;
128 bfd_vma addend;
129 };
130
131 /* This structure describes a range of addends: [MIN_ADDEND, MAX_ADDEND].
132 The structures form a non-overlapping list that is sorted by increasing
133 MIN_ADDEND. */
134 struct mips_got_page_range
135 {
136 struct mips_got_page_range *next;
137 bfd_signed_vma min_addend;
138 bfd_signed_vma max_addend;
139 };
140
141 /* This structure describes the range of addends that are applied to page
142 relocations against a given section. */
143 struct mips_got_page_entry
144 {
145 /* The section that these entries are based on. */
146 asection *sec;
147 /* The ranges for this page entry. */
148 struct mips_got_page_range *ranges;
149 /* The maximum number of page entries needed for RANGES. */
150 bfd_vma num_pages;
151 };
152
153 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
154
155 struct mips_got_info
156 {
157 /* The number of global .got entries. */
158 unsigned int global_gotno;
159 /* The number of global .got entries that are in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area. */
160 unsigned int reloc_only_gotno;
161 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
162 unsigned int tls_gotno;
163 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
164 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
165 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
166 /* The number of local .got entries, eventually including page entries. */
167 unsigned int local_gotno;
168 /* The maximum number of page entries needed. */
169 unsigned int page_gotno;
170 /* The number of relocations needed for the GOT entries. */
171 unsigned int relocs;
172 /* The first unused local .got entry. */
173 unsigned int assigned_low_gotno;
174 /* The last unused local .got entry. */
175 unsigned int assigned_high_gotno;
176 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
177 struct htab *got_entries;
178 /* A hash table holding mips_got_page_ref structures. */
179 struct htab *got_page_refs;
180 /* A hash table of mips_got_page_entry structures. */
181 struct htab *got_page_entries;
182 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
183 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
184 struct mips_got_info *next;
185 };
186
187 /* Structure passed when merging bfds' gots. */
188
189 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
190 {
191 /* The output bfd. */
192 bfd *obfd;
193 /* The link information. */
194 struct bfd_link_info *info;
195 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
196 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
197 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
198 struct mips_got_info *primary;
199 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
200 gots. */
201 struct mips_got_info *current;
202 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
203 16-bit offset. */
204 unsigned int max_count;
205 /* The maximum number of page entries needed by each got. */
206 unsigned int max_pages;
207 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
208 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
209 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
210 the "master" GOT. */
211 unsigned int global_count;
212 };
213
214 /* A structure used to pass information to htab_traverse callbacks
215 when laying out the GOT. */
216
217 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg
218 {
219 struct bfd_link_info *info;
220 struct mips_got_info *g;
221 int value;
222 };
223
224 struct _mips_elf_section_data
225 {
226 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
227 union
228 {
229 bfd_byte *tdata;
230 } u;
231 };
232
233 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
234 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
235
236 #define is_mips_elf(bfd) \
237 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
238 && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
239 && elf_object_id (bfd) == MIPS_ELF_DATA)
240
241 /* The ABI says that every symbol used by dynamic relocations must have
242 a global GOT entry. Among other things, this provides the dynamic
243 linker with a free, directly-indexed cache. The GOT can therefore
244 contain symbols that are not referenced by GOT relocations themselves
245 (in other words, it may have symbols that are not referenced by things
246 like R_MIPS_GOT16 and R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE).
247
248 GOT relocations are less likely to overflow if we put the associated
249 GOT entries towards the beginning. We therefore divide the global
250 GOT entries into two areas: "normal" and "reloc-only". Entries in
251 the first area can be used for both dynamic relocations and GP-relative
252 accesses, while those in the "reloc-only" area are for dynamic
253 relocations only.
254
255 These GGA_* ("Global GOT Area") values are organised so that lower
256 values are more general than higher values. Also, non-GGA_NONE
257 values are ordered by the position of the area in the GOT. */
258 #define GGA_NORMAL 0
259 #define GGA_RELOC_ONLY 1
260 #define GGA_NONE 2
261
262 /* Information about a non-PIC interface to a PIC function. There are
263 two ways of creating these interfaces. The first is to add:
264
265 lui $25,%hi(func)
266 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
267
268 immediately before a PIC function "func". The second is to add:
269
270 lui $25,%hi(func)
271 j func
272 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
273
274 to a separate trampoline section.
275
276 Stubs of the first kind go in a new section immediately before the
277 target function. Stubs of the second kind go in a single section
278 pointed to by the hash table's "strampoline" field. */
279 struct mips_elf_la25_stub {
280 /* The generated section that contains this stub. */
281 asection *stub_section;
282
283 /* The offset of the stub from the start of STUB_SECTION. */
284 bfd_vma offset;
285
286 /* One symbol for the original function. Its location is available
287 in H->root.root.u.def. */
288 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
289 };
290
291 /* Macros for populating a mips_elf_la25_stub. */
292
293 #define LA25_LUI(VAL) (0x3c190000 | (VAL)) /* lui t9,VAL */
294 #define LA25_J(VAL) (0x08000000 | (((VAL) >> 2) & 0x3ffffff)) /* j VAL */
295 #define LA25_ADDIU(VAL) (0x27390000 | (VAL)) /* addiu t9,t9,VAL */
296 #define LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
297 (0x41b90000 | (VAL)) /* lui t9,VAL */
298 #define LA25_J_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
299 (0xd4000000 | (((VAL) >> 1) & 0x3ffffff)) /* j VAL */
300 #define LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
301 (0x33390000 | (VAL)) /* addiu t9,t9,VAL */
302
303 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
304 the dynamic symbols. */
305
306 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
307 {
308 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
309 index. */
310 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
311 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
312 symbol with a GOT entry. */
313 bfd_size_type min_got_dynindx;
314 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
315 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
316 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
317 bfd_size_type max_unref_got_dynindx;
318 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a local
319 symbol. */
320 bfd_size_type max_local_dynindx;
321 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to an external
322 symbol without a GOT entry. */
323 bfd_size_type max_non_got_dynindx;
324 };
325
326 /* We make up to two PLT entries if needed, one for standard MIPS code
327 and one for compressed code, either a MIPS16 or microMIPS one. We
328 keep a separate record of traditional lazy-binding stubs, for easier
329 processing. */
330
331 struct plt_entry
332 {
333 /* Traditional SVR4 stub offset, or -1 if none. */
334 bfd_vma stub_offset;
335
336 /* Standard PLT entry offset, or -1 if none. */
337 bfd_vma mips_offset;
338
339 /* Compressed PLT entry offset, or -1 if none. */
340 bfd_vma comp_offset;
341
342 /* The corresponding .got.plt index, or -1 if none. */
343 bfd_vma gotplt_index;
344
345 /* Whether we need a standard PLT entry. */
346 unsigned int need_mips : 1;
347
348 /* Whether we need a compressed PLT entry. */
349 unsigned int need_comp : 1;
350 };
351
352 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
353 the global hash table. */
354
355 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
356 {
357 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
358
359 /* External symbol information. */
360 EXTR esym;
361
362 /* The la25 stub we have created for ths symbol, if any. */
363 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *la25_stub;
364
365 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
366 this symbol. */
367 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
368
369 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
370 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
371 asection *fn_stub;
372
373 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
374 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
375 asection *call_stub;
376
377 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
378 being called returns a floating point value. */
379 asection *call_fp_stub;
380
381 /* The highest GGA_* value that satisfies all references to this symbol. */
382 unsigned int global_got_area : 2;
383
384 /* True if all GOT relocations against this symbol are for calls. This is
385 a looser condition than no_fn_stub below, because there may be other
386 non-call non-GOT relocations against the symbol. */
387 unsigned int got_only_for_calls : 1;
388
389 /* True if one of the relocations described by possibly_dynamic_relocs
390 is against a readonly section. */
391 unsigned int readonly_reloc : 1;
392
393 /* True if there is a relocation against this symbol that must be
394 resolved by the static linker (in other words, if the relocation
395 cannot possibly be made dynamic). */
396 unsigned int has_static_relocs : 1;
397
398 /* True if we must not create a .MIPS.stubs entry for this symbol.
399 This is set, for example, if there are relocations related to
400 taking the function's address, i.e. any but R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones.
401 See "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition", p. 4-20. */
402 unsigned int no_fn_stub : 1;
403
404 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is true if this symbol appears
405 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
406 unsigned int need_fn_stub : 1;
407
408 /* True if this symbol is referenced by branch relocations from
409 any non-PIC input file. This is used to determine whether an
410 la25 stub is required. */
411 unsigned int has_nonpic_branches : 1;
412
413 /* Does this symbol need a traditional MIPS lazy-binding stub
414 (as opposed to a PLT entry)? */
415 unsigned int needs_lazy_stub : 1;
416
417 /* Does this symbol resolve to a PLT entry? */
418 unsigned int use_plt_entry : 1;
419 };
420
421 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
422
423 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
424 {
425 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
426
427 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
428 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
429
430 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
431 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
432
433 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic entry
434 is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5 and IRIX6. */
435 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
436
437 /* The __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
438 struct elf_link_hash_entry *rld_symbol;
439
440 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
441 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
442
443 /* True if we can generate copy relocs and PLTs. */
444 bfd_boolean use_plts_and_copy_relocs;
445
446 /* True if we can only use 32-bit microMIPS instructions. */
447 bfd_boolean insn32;
448
449 /* True if we suppress checks for invalid branches between ISA modes. */
450 bfd_boolean ignore_branch_isa;
451
452 /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks. */
453 bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
454
455 /* True if we already reported the small-data section overflow. */
456 bfd_boolean small_data_overflow_reported;
457
458 /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
459 being used. */
460 asection *srelplt2;
461 asection *sstubs;
462
463 /* The master GOT information. */
464 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
465
466 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
467 symbol table. */
468 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
469
470 /* The size of the PLT header in bytes. */
471 bfd_vma plt_header_size;
472
473 /* The size of a standard PLT entry in bytes. */
474 bfd_vma plt_mips_entry_size;
475
476 /* The size of a compressed PLT entry in bytes. */
477 bfd_vma plt_comp_entry_size;
478
479 /* The offset of the next standard PLT entry to create. */
480 bfd_vma plt_mips_offset;
481
482 /* The offset of the next compressed PLT entry to create. */
483 bfd_vma plt_comp_offset;
484
485 /* The index of the next .got.plt entry to create. */
486 bfd_vma plt_got_index;
487
488 /* The number of functions that need a lazy-binding stub. */
489 bfd_vma lazy_stub_count;
490
491 /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes. */
492 bfd_vma function_stub_size;
493
494 /* The number of reserved entries at the beginning of the GOT. */
495 unsigned int reserved_gotno;
496
497 /* The section used for mips_elf_la25_stub trampolines.
498 See the comment above that structure for details. */
499 asection *strampoline;
500
501 /* A table of mips_elf_la25_stubs, indexed by (input_section, offset)
502 pairs. */
503 htab_t la25_stubs;
504
505 /* A function FN (NAME, IS, OS) that creates a new input section
506 called NAME and links it to output section OS. If IS is nonnull,
507 the new section should go immediately before it, otherwise it
508 should go at the (current) beginning of OS.
509
510 The function returns the new section on success, otherwise it
511 returns null. */
512 asection *(*add_stub_section) (const char *, asection *, asection *);
513
514 /* Small local sym cache. */
515 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
516
517 /* Is the PLT header compressed? */
518 unsigned int plt_header_is_comp : 1;
519 };
520
521 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
522
523 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
524 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
525 == MIPS_ELF_DATA ? ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
526
527 /* A structure used to communicate with htab_traverse callbacks. */
528 struct mips_htab_traverse_info
529 {
530 /* The usual link-wide information. */
531 struct bfd_link_info *info;
532 bfd *output_bfd;
533
534 /* Starts off FALSE and is set to TRUE if the link should be aborted. */
535 bfd_boolean error;
536 };
537
538 /* MIPS ELF private object data. */
539
540 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata
541 {
542 /* Generic ELF private object data. */
543 struct elf_obj_tdata root;
544
545 /* Input BFD providing Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attribute for output. */
546 bfd *abi_fp_bfd;
547
548 /* Input BFD providing Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA attribute for output. */
549 bfd *abi_msa_bfd;
550
551 /* The abiflags for this object. */
552 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 abiflags;
553 bfd_boolean abiflags_valid;
554
555 /* The GOT requirements of input bfds. */
556 struct mips_got_info *got;
557
558 /* Used by _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line. The structure could be
559 included directly in this one, but there's no point to wasting
560 the memory just for the infrequently called find_nearest_line. */
561 struct mips_elf_find_line *find_line_info;
562
563 /* An array of stub sections indexed by symbol number. */
564 asection **local_stubs;
565 asection **local_call_stubs;
566
567 /* The Irix 5 support uses two virtual sections, which represent
568 text/data symbols defined in dynamic objects. */
569 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
570 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
571 asection *elf_data_section;
572 asection *elf_text_section;
573 };
574
575 /* Get MIPS ELF private object data from BFD's tdata. */
576
577 #define mips_elf_tdata(bfd) \
578 ((struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
579
580 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
581 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
582 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
583 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
584 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
585 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
586 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
587 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
588 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
589 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
590 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
591 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
592 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
593 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16 \
594 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GD \
595 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM \
596 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
597 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
598 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL \
599 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
600 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16 \
601 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD \
602 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM \
603 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
604 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
605 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
606 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
607 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
608
609 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
610
611 struct extsym_info
612 {
613 bfd *abfd;
614 struct bfd_link_info *info;
615 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
616 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
617 bfd_boolean failed;
618 };
619
620 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
621
622 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
623 {
624 "_procedure_table",
625 "_procedure_string_table",
626 "_procedure_table_size",
627 NULL
628 };
629
630 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
631 IRIX5. */
632
633 typedef struct
634 {
635 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
636 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
637 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
638 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
639 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
640 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
641 } Elf32_compact_rel;
642
643 typedef struct
644 {
645 bfd_byte id1[4];
646 bfd_byte num[4];
647 bfd_byte id2[4];
648 bfd_byte offset[4];
649 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
650 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
651 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
652
653 typedef struct
654 {
655 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
656 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
657 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
658 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
659 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
660 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
661 } Elf32_crinfo;
662
663 typedef struct
664 {
665 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
666 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
667 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
668 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
669 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
670 } Elf32_crinfo2;
671
672 typedef struct
673 {
674 bfd_byte info[4];
675 bfd_byte konst[4];
676 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
677 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
678
679 typedef struct
680 {
681 bfd_byte info[4];
682 bfd_byte konst[4];
683 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
684
685 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
686
687 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
688 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
689 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
690 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
691 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
692 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
693 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
694 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
695
696 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
697 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
698 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
699 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
700 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
701
702 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
703 has different meaning for each type:
704
705 (type) (konst)
706 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
707 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
708 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
709 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
710 */
711
712 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
713 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
714 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
715 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
716
717 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
718 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
719 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
720 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
721 \f
722 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
723 loader for use by the static exception system. */
724
725 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
726 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
727 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
728 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
729 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
730 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
731 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
732 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
733 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
734 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
735 long reserved;
736 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
737 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
738 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
739 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
740 \f
741 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
742 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, bfd_vma, unsigned long,
743 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
744 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
745 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
746 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
747 (bfd_vma);
748 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
749 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
750 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
751 bfd_vma *, asection *);
752 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
753 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
754
755 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
756 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
757
758 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs with load interlocking that include
759 non-MIPS1 CPUs and R3900. */
760 #define LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P(abfd) \
761 ( ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) != E_MIPS_ARCH_1) \
762 || ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_3900))
763
764 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JAL is converted to BAL.
765 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate
766 for RM9000 for now. */
767 #define JAL_TO_BAL_P(abfd) \
768 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_9000)
769
770 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JALR is converted to BAL.
771 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
772 all CPUs. */
773 #define JALR_TO_BAL_P(abfd) 1
774
775 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JR is converted to B.
776 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
777 all CPUs. */
778 #define JR_TO_B_P(abfd) 1
779
780 /* True if ABFD is a PIC object. */
781 #define PIC_OBJECT_P(abfd) \
782 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC) != 0)
783
784 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the O32 ABI. */
785 #define ABI_O32_P(abfd) \
786 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
787
788 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
789 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
790 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
791
792 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
793 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
794 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
795
796 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
797 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
798
799 /* Nonzero if ABFD has microMIPS code. */
800 #define MICROMIPS_P(abfd) \
801 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS) != 0)
802
803 /* Nonzero if ABFD is MIPS R6. */
804 #define MIPSR6_P(abfd) \
805 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6 \
806 || (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6)
807
808 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
809 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
810 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
811
812 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
813 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
814 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
815
816 /* The name of the options section. */
817 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
818 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
819
820 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
821 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
822 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
823 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
824
825 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS section. */
826 #define MIPS_ELF_ABIFLAGS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
827 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.abiflags") == 0)
828
829 /* Whether the section is readonly. */
830 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
831 ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)) \
832 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
833
834 /* The name of the stub section. */
835 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
836
837 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
838 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
839 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
840
841 /* The size of an external RELA relocation. */
842 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
843 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
844
845 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
846 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
847 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
848
849 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
850 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
851 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
852
853 /* The size of the .rld_map section. */
854 #define MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE(abfd) \
855 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
856
857 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
858 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
859 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
860
861 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
862 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
863 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
864
865 /* Get word-sized data. */
866 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
867 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
868
869 /* Put out word-sized data. */
870 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
871 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
872 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
873 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
874
875 /* The opcode for word-sized loads (LW or LD). */
876 #define MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD(abfd) \
877 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 0xdc000000 : 0x8c000000)
878
879 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
880 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
881 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
882
883 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
884 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
885
886 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section. */
887 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
888 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
889
890 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
891 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
892 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
893 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
894
895 /* The value to write into got[1] for SVR4 targets, to identify it is
896 a GNU object. The dynamic linker can then use got[1] to store the
897 module pointer. */
898 #define MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK(abfd) \
899 ((bfd_vma) 1 << (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 63 : 31))
900
901 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
902 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
903 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
904
905 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
906 offsets from $gp. */
907 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
908
909 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
910 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
911 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
912 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
913 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
914 #define STUB_MOVE 0x03e07825 /* or t7,ra,zero */
915 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
916 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr ra,t9 */
917 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
918 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
919 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL) \
920 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
921 ? (0x64180000 + (VAL)) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
922 : (0x24180000 + (VAL)))) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
923
924 /* Likewise for the microMIPS ASE. */
925 #define STUB_LW_MICROMIPS(abfd) \
926 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
927 ? 0xdf3c8010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
928 : 0xff3c8010) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
929 #define STUB_MOVE_MICROMIPS 0x0dff /* move t7,ra */
930 #define STUB_MOVE32_MICROMIPS 0x001f7a90 /* or t7,ra,zero */
931 #define STUB_LUI_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
932 (0x41b80000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
933 #define STUB_JALR_MICROMIPS 0x45d9 /* jalr t9 */
934 #define STUB_JALR32_MICROMIPS 0x03f90f3c /* jalr ra,t9 */
935 #define STUB_ORI_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
936 (0x53180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
937 #define STUB_LI16U_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
938 (0x53000000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
939 #define STUB_LI16S_MICROMIPS(abfd, VAL) \
940 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
941 ? 0x5f000000 + (VAL) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
942 : 0x33000000 + (VAL)) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
943
944 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
945 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
946 #define MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 12
947 #define MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 16
948 #define MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
949 #define MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
950
951 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
952 section. */
953
954 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
955 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
956 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
957 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
958
959 #ifdef BFD64
960 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
961 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
962 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
963 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
964 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
965 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
966 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
967 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
968 #else
969 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
970 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
971 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
972 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
973 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
974 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
975 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
976 #endif
977 \f
978 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
979 floating point arguments.
980
981 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
982 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
983 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
984 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
985 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
986 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
987 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
988 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
989
990 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
991 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
992 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
993 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
994 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
995 stub should be discarded.
996
997 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
998 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
999 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
1000 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
1001 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
1002 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
1003 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
1004 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
1005
1006 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
1007 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
1008 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
1009
1010 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
1011
1012 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
1013 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
1014 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
1015
1016 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
1017 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
1018 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
1019 \f
1020 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an O32 executable. */
1021 static const bfd_vma mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1022 {
1023 0x3c1c0000, /* lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1024 0x8f990000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28) */
1025 0x279c0000, /* addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1026 0x031cc023, /* subu $24, $24, $28 */
1027 0x03e07825, /* or t7, ra, zero */
1028 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1029 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
1030 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1031 };
1032
1033 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N32 executable. Different
1034 because gp ($28) is not available; we use t2 ($14) instead. */
1035 static const bfd_vma mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1036 {
1037 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1038 0x8dd90000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
1039 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1040 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
1041 0x03e07825, /* or t7, ra, zero */
1042 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1043 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
1044 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1045 };
1046
1047 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N64 executable. Different
1048 from N32 because of the increased size of GOT entries. */
1049 static const bfd_vma mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1050 {
1051 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1052 0xddd90000, /* ld $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
1053 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1054 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
1055 0x03e07825, /* or t7, ra, zero */
1056 0x0018c0c2, /* srl $24, $24, 3 */
1057 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
1058 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1059 };
1060
1061 /* The format of the microMIPS first PLT entry in an O32 executable.
1062 We rely on v0 ($2) rather than t8 ($24) to contain the address
1063 of the GOTPLT entry handled, so this stub may only be used when
1064 all the subsequent PLT entries are microMIPS code too.
1065
1066 The trailing NOP is for alignment and correct disassembly only. */
1067 static const bfd_vma micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1068 {
1069 0x7980, 0x0000, /* addiupc $3, (&GOTPLT[0]) - . */
1070 0xff23, 0x0000, /* lw $25, 0($3) */
1071 0x0535, /* subu $2, $2, $3 */
1072 0x2525, /* srl $2, $2, 2 */
1073 0x3302, 0xfffe, /* subu $24, $2, 2 */
1074 0x0dff, /* move $15, $31 */
1075 0x45f9, /* jalrs $25 */
1076 0x0f83, /* move $28, $3 */
1077 0x0c00 /* nop */
1078 };
1079
1080 /* The format of the microMIPS first PLT entry in an O32 executable
1081 in the insn32 mode. */
1082 static const bfd_vma micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1083 {
1084 0x41bc, 0x0000, /* lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1085 0xff3c, 0x0000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28) */
1086 0x339c, 0x0000, /* addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1087 0x0398, 0xc1d0, /* subu $24, $24, $28 */
1088 0x001f, 0x7a90, /* or $15, $31, zero */
1089 0x0318, 0x1040, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1090 0x03f9, 0x0f3c, /* jalr $25 */
1091 0x3318, 0xfffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1092 };
1093
1094 /* The format of subsequent standard PLT entries. */
1095 static const bfd_vma mips_exec_plt_entry[] =
1096 {
1097 0x3c0f0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
1098 0x01f90000, /* l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
1099 0x25f80000, /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
1100 0x03200008 /* jr $25 */
1101 };
1102
1103 /* In the following PLT entry the JR and ADDIU instructions will
1104 be swapped in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol because
1105 LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P will be true for MIPS R6. */
1106 static const bfd_vma mipsr6_exec_plt_entry[] =
1107 {
1108 0x3c0f0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
1109 0x01f90000, /* l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
1110 0x25f80000, /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
1111 0x03200009 /* jr $25 */
1112 };
1113
1114 /* The format of subsequent MIPS16 o32 PLT entries. We use v0 ($2)
1115 and v1 ($3) as temporaries because t8 ($24) and t9 ($25) are not
1116 directly addressable. */
1117 static const bfd_vma mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry[] =
1118 {
1119 0xb203, /* lw $2, 12($pc) */
1120 0x9a60, /* lw $3, 0($2) */
1121 0x651a, /* move $24, $2 */
1122 0xeb00, /* jr $3 */
1123 0x653b, /* move $25, $3 */
1124 0x6500, /* nop */
1125 0x0000, 0x0000 /* .word (.got.plt entry) */
1126 };
1127
1128 /* The format of subsequent microMIPS o32 PLT entries. We use v0 ($2)
1129 as a temporary because t8 ($24) is not addressable with ADDIUPC. */
1130 static const bfd_vma micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry[] =
1131 {
1132 0x7900, 0x0000, /* addiupc $2, (.got.plt entry) - . */
1133 0xff22, 0x0000, /* lw $25, 0($2) */
1134 0x4599, /* jr $25 */
1135 0x0f02 /* move $24, $2 */
1136 };
1137
1138 /* The format of subsequent microMIPS o32 PLT entries in the insn32 mode. */
1139 static const bfd_vma micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry[] =
1140 {
1141 0x41af, 0x0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
1142 0xff2f, 0x0000, /* lw $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
1143 0x0019, 0x0f3c, /* jr $25 */
1144 0x330f, 0x0000 /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
1145 };
1146
1147 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable. */
1148 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1149 {
1150 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
1151 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
1152 0x8f390008, /* lw t9, 8(t9) */
1153 0x00000000, /* nop */
1154 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1155 0x00000000 /* nop */
1156 };
1157
1158 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
1159 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] =
1160 {
1161 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
1162 0x24180000, /* li t8, <pltindex> */
1163 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>) */
1164 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>) */
1165 0x8f390000, /* lw t9, 0(t9) */
1166 0x00000000, /* nop */
1167 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1168 0x00000000 /* nop */
1169 };
1170
1171 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object. */
1172 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] =
1173 {
1174 0x8f990008, /* lw t9, 8(gp) */
1175 0x00000000, /* nop */
1176 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1177 0x00000000, /* nop */
1178 0x00000000, /* nop */
1179 0x00000000 /* nop */
1180 };
1181
1182 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
1183 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] =
1184 {
1185 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
1186 0x24180000 /* li t8, <pltindex> */
1187 };
1188 \f
1189 /* microMIPS 32-bit opcode helper installer. */
1190
1191 static void
1192 bfd_put_micromips_32 (const bfd *abfd, bfd_vma opcode, bfd_byte *ptr)
1193 {
1194 bfd_put_16 (abfd, (opcode >> 16) & 0xffff, ptr);
1195 bfd_put_16 (abfd, opcode & 0xffff, ptr + 2);
1196 }
1197
1198 /* microMIPS 32-bit opcode helper retriever. */
1199
1200 static bfd_vma
1201 bfd_get_micromips_32 (const bfd *abfd, const bfd_byte *ptr)
1202 {
1203 return (bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr) << 16) | bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr + 2);
1204 }
1205 \f
1206 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1207
1208 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
1209 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
1210 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
1211 (copy), (follow)))
1212
1213 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1214
1215 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
1216 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
1217 (&(table)->root, \
1218 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
1219 (info)))
1220
1221 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
1222 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
1223
1224 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
1225 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
1226
1227 static bfd_vma
1228 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1229 {
1230 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1231 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1232 return 0;
1233 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
1234 }
1235
1236 static bfd_vma
1237 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1238 {
1239 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1240 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1241 return 0;
1242 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1246
1247 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
1248 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
1249 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
1250 {
1251 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
1252 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
1253
1254 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
1255 subclass. */
1256 if (ret == NULL)
1257 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
1258 if (ret == NULL)
1259 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1260
1261 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
1262 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
1263 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
1264 table, string));
1265 if (ret != NULL)
1266 {
1267 /* Set local fields. */
1268 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
1269 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
1270 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
1271 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
1272 ret->la25_stub = 0;
1273 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
1274 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
1275 ret->call_stub = NULL;
1276 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
1277 ret->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
1278 ret->got_only_for_calls = TRUE;
1279 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
1280 ret->has_static_relocs = FALSE;
1281 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
1282 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
1283 ret->has_nonpic_branches = FALSE;
1284 ret->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
1285 ret->use_plt_entry = FALSE;
1286 }
1287
1288 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1289 }
1290
1291 /* Allocate MIPS ELF private object data. */
1292
1293 bfd_boolean
1294 _bfd_mips_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1295 {
1296 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_obj_tdata),
1297 MIPS_ELF_DATA);
1298 }
1299
1300 bfd_boolean
1301 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1302 {
1303 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
1304 {
1305 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
1306 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
1307
1308 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1309 if (sdata == NULL)
1310 return FALSE;
1311 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
1312 }
1313
1314 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
1315 }
1316 \f
1317 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
1318 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
1319
1320 bfd_boolean
1321 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
1322 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1323 {
1324 HDRR *symhdr;
1325 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1326 char *ext_hdr;
1327
1328 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1329 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
1330
1331 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
1332 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
1333 goto error_return;
1334
1335 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
1336 swap->external_hdr_size))
1337 goto error_return;
1338
1339 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1340 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
1341
1342 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
1343 read. */
1344 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
1345 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
1346 debug->ptr = NULL; \
1347 else \
1348 { \
1349 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
1350 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
1351 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
1352 goto error_return; \
1353 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
1354 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
1355 goto error_return; \
1356 }
1357
1358 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
1359 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
1360 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
1361 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
1362 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
1363 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
1364 union aux_ext *);
1365 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1366 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1367 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
1368 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
1369 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
1370 #undef READ
1371
1372 debug->fdr = NULL;
1373
1374 return TRUE;
1375
1376 error_return:
1377 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
1378 free (ext_hdr);
1379 if (debug->line != NULL)
1380 free (debug->line);
1381 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
1382 free (debug->external_dnr);
1383 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
1384 free (debug->external_pdr);
1385 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
1386 free (debug->external_sym);
1387 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
1388 free (debug->external_opt);
1389 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
1390 free (debug->external_aux);
1391 if (debug->ss != NULL)
1392 free (debug->ss);
1393 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
1394 free (debug->ssext);
1395 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
1396 free (debug->external_fdr);
1397 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
1398 free (debug->external_rfd);
1399 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
1400 free (debug->external_ext);
1401 return FALSE;
1402 }
1403 \f
1404 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
1405
1406 static void
1407 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
1408 {
1409 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
1410 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
1411 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
1412 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
1413 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
1414 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
1415
1416 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
1417 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
1418
1419 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
1420 }
1421
1422 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
1423
1424 static bfd_boolean
1425 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
1426 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
1427 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1428 {
1429 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1430 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1431 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
1432 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
1433 void *rtproc;
1434 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
1435 struct sym_ext *esym;
1436 char *ss, **sv;
1437 char *str;
1438 bfd_size_type size;
1439 bfd_size_type count;
1440 unsigned long sindex;
1441 unsigned long i;
1442 PDR pdr;
1443 SYMR sym;
1444 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
1445
1446 epdr = NULL;
1447 rpdr = NULL;
1448 esym = NULL;
1449 ss = NULL;
1450 sv = NULL;
1451
1452 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1453
1454 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1455 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1456 if (count > 0)
1457 {
1458 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1459
1460 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1461 if (epdr == NULL)
1462 goto error_return;
1463
1464 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1465 goto error_return;
1466
1467 size = sizeof (RPDR);
1468 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1469 if (rpdr == NULL)
1470 goto error_return;
1471
1472 size = sizeof (char *);
1473 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1474 if (sv == NULL)
1475 goto error_return;
1476
1477 count = hdr->isymMax;
1478 size = swap->external_sym_size;
1479 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1480 if (esym == NULL)
1481 goto error_return;
1482
1483 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1484 goto error_return;
1485
1486 count = hdr->issMax;
1487 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1488 if (ss == NULL)
1489 goto error_return;
1490 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1491 goto error_return;
1492
1493 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1494 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1495 {
1496 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1497 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1498 rp->adr = sym.value;
1499 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1500 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1501 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1502 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1503 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1504 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1505 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1506 rp->irpss = sindex;
1507 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1508 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1509 }
1510 }
1511
1512 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1513 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1514 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1515 if (rtproc == NULL)
1516 {
1517 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1518 goto error_return;
1519 }
1520
1521 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1522
1523 erp = rtproc;
1524 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1525 erp++;
1526 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1527 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1528 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1529 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1530 {
1531 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1532 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1533 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1534 }
1535 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1536
1537 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
1538 s->size = size;
1539 s->contents = rtproc;
1540
1541 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1542 matters, but someday it might). */
1543 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1544
1545 if (epdr != NULL)
1546 free (epdr);
1547 if (rpdr != NULL)
1548 free (rpdr);
1549 if (esym != NULL)
1550 free (esym);
1551 if (ss != NULL)
1552 free (ss);
1553 if (sv != NULL)
1554 free (sv);
1555
1556 return TRUE;
1557
1558 error_return:
1559 if (epdr != NULL)
1560 free (epdr);
1561 if (rpdr != NULL)
1562 free (rpdr);
1563 if (esym != NULL)
1564 free (esym);
1565 if (ss != NULL)
1566 free (ss);
1567 if (sv != NULL)
1568 free (sv);
1569 return FALSE;
1570 }
1571 \f
1572 /* We're going to create a stub for H. Create a symbol for the stub's
1573 value and size, to help make the disassembly easier to read. */
1574
1575 static bfd_boolean
1576 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1577 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1578 const char *prefix, asection *s, bfd_vma value,
1579 bfd_vma size)
1580 {
1581 bfd_boolean micromips_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other);
1582 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1583 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1584 char *name;
1585 bfd_boolean res;
1586
1587 if (micromips_p)
1588 value |= 1;
1589
1590 /* Create a new symbol. */
1591 name = concat (prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL);
1592 bh = NULL;
1593 res = _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1594 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1595 TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
1596 free (name);
1597 if (! res)
1598 return FALSE;
1599
1600 /* Make it a local function. */
1601 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1602 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
1603 elfh->size = size;
1604 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1605 if (micromips_p)
1606 elfh->other = ELF_ST_SET_MICROMIPS (elfh->other);
1607 return TRUE;
1608 }
1609
1610 /* We're about to redefine H. Create a symbol to represent H's
1611 current value and size, to help make the disassembly easier
1612 to read. */
1613
1614 static bfd_boolean
1615 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1616 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1617 const char *prefix)
1618 {
1619 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1620 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1621 char *name;
1622 asection *s;
1623 bfd_vma value;
1624 bfd_boolean res;
1625
1626 /* Read the symbol's value. */
1627 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1628 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
1629 s = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1630 value = h->root.root.u.def.value;
1631
1632 /* Create a new symbol. */
1633 name = concat (prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL);
1634 bh = NULL;
1635 res = _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1636 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1637 TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
1638 free (name);
1639 if (! res)
1640 return FALSE;
1641
1642 /* Make it local and copy the other attributes from H. */
1643 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1644 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, ELF_ST_TYPE (h->root.type));
1645 elfh->other = h->root.other;
1646 elfh->size = h->root.size;
1647 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1648 return TRUE;
1649 }
1650
1651 /* Return TRUE if relocations in SECTION can refer directly to a MIPS16
1652 function rather than to a hard-float stub. */
1653
1654 static bfd_boolean
1655 section_allows_mips16_refs_p (asection *section)
1656 {
1657 const char *name;
1658
1659 name = bfd_get_section_name (section->owner, section);
1660 return (FN_STUB_P (name)
1661 || CALL_STUB_P (name)
1662 || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name)
1663 || strcmp (name, ".pdr") == 0);
1664 }
1665
1666 /* [RELOCS, RELEND) are the relocations against SEC, which is a MIPS16
1667 stub section of some kind. Return the R_SYMNDX of the target
1668 function, or 0 if we can't decide which function that is. */
1669
1670 static unsigned long
1671 mips16_stub_symndx (const struct elf_backend_data *bed,
1672 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1673 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
1674 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
1675 {
1676 int int_rels_per_ext_rel = bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
1677 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
1678
1679 /* Trust the first R_MIPS_NONE relocation, if any, but not a subsequent
1680 one in a compound relocation. */
1681 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel += int_rels_per_ext_rel)
1682 if (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info) == R_MIPS_NONE)
1683 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, rel->r_info);
1684
1685 /* Otherwise trust the first relocation, whatever its kind. This is
1686 the traditional behavior. */
1687 if (relocs < relend)
1688 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, relocs->r_info);
1689
1690 return 0;
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1694 discard them. */
1695
1696 static void
1697 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1698 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1699 {
1700 /* Dynamic symbols must use the standard call interface, in case other
1701 objects try to call them. */
1702 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1703 && h->root.dynindx != -1)
1704 {
1705 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (info, h, ".mips16.");
1706 h->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
1707 }
1708
1709 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1710 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1711 {
1712 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1713 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1714 being included in the link. */
1715 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1716 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1717 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1718 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1719 h->fn_stub->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1720 }
1721
1722 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1723 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1724 {
1725 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1726 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1727 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1728 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1729 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1730 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1731 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1732 h->call_stub->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1733 }
1734
1735 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1736 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1737 {
1738 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1739 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1740 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1741 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1742 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1743 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1744 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1745 h->call_fp_stub->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1746 }
1747 }
1748
1749 /* Hashtable callbacks for mips_elf_la25_stubs. */
1750
1751 static hashval_t
1752 mips_elf_la25_stub_hash (const void *entry_)
1753 {
1754 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry;
1755
1756 entry = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry_;
1757 return entry->h->root.root.u.def.section->id
1758 + entry->h->root.root.u.def.value;
1759 }
1760
1761 static int
1762 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
1763 {
1764 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry1, *entry2;
1765
1766 entry1 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry1_;
1767 entry2 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry2_;
1768 return ((entry1->h->root.root.u.def.section
1769 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.section)
1770 && (entry1->h->root.root.u.def.value
1771 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.value));
1772 }
1773
1774 /* Called by the linker to set up the la25 stub-creation code. FN is
1775 the linker's implementation of add_stub_function. Return true on
1776 success. */
1777
1778 bfd_boolean
1779 _bfd_mips_elf_init_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1780 asection *(*fn) (const char *, asection *,
1781 asection *))
1782 {
1783 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1784
1785 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1786 if (htab == NULL)
1787 return FALSE;
1788
1789 htab->add_stub_section = fn;
1790 htab->la25_stubs = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_la25_stub_hash,
1791 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq, NULL);
1792 if (htab->la25_stubs == NULL)
1793 return FALSE;
1794
1795 return TRUE;
1796 }
1797
1798 /* Return true if H is a locally-defined PIC function, in the sense
1799 that it or its fn_stub might need $25 to be valid on entry.
1800 Note that MIPS16 functions set up $gp using PC-relative instructions,
1801 so they themselves never need $25 to be valid. Only non-MIPS16
1802 entry points are of interest here. */
1803
1804 static bfd_boolean
1805 mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1806 {
1807 return ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1808 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1809 && h->root.def_regular
1810 && !bfd_is_abs_section (h->root.root.u.def.section)
1811 && !bfd_is_und_section (h->root.root.u.def.section)
1812 && (!ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other)
1813 || (h->fn_stub && h->need_fn_stub))
1814 && (PIC_OBJECT_P (h->root.root.u.def.section->owner)
1815 || ELF_ST_IS_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other)));
1816 }
1817
1818 /* Set *SEC to the input section that contains the target of STUB.
1819 Return the offset of the target from the start of that section. */
1820
1821 static bfd_vma
1822 mips_elf_get_la25_target (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1823 asection **sec)
1824 {
1825 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (stub->h->root.other))
1826 {
1827 BFD_ASSERT (stub->h->need_fn_stub);
1828 *sec = stub->h->fn_stub;
1829 return 0;
1830 }
1831 else
1832 {
1833 *sec = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1834 return stub->h->root.root.u.def.value;
1835 }
1836 }
1837
1838 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1839 by inserting an LUI/ADDIU pair before the target function.
1840 Create the section and redirect the function symbol to it. */
1841
1842 static bfd_boolean
1843 mips_elf_add_la25_intro (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1844 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1845 {
1846 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1847 char *name;
1848 asection *s, *input_section;
1849 unsigned int align;
1850
1851 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1852 if (htab == NULL)
1853 return FALSE;
1854
1855 /* Create a unique name for the new section. */
1856 name = bfd_malloc (11 + sizeof (".text.stub."));
1857 if (name == NULL)
1858 return FALSE;
1859 sprintf (name, ".text.stub.%d", (int) htab_elements (htab->la25_stubs));
1860
1861 /* Create the section. */
1862 mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &input_section);
1863 s = htab->add_stub_section (name, input_section,
1864 input_section->output_section);
1865 if (s == NULL)
1866 return FALSE;
1867
1868 /* Make sure that any padding goes before the stub. */
1869 align = input_section->alignment_power;
1870 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, align))
1871 return FALSE;
1872 if (align > 3)
1873 s->size = (1 << align) - 8;
1874
1875 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1876 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 8);
1877 stub->stub_section = s;
1878 stub->offset = s->size;
1879
1880 /* Allocate room for it. */
1881 s->size += 8;
1882 return TRUE;
1883 }
1884
1885 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1886 with a separate trampoline. Allocate room for it and redirect
1887 the function symbol to it. */
1888
1889 static bfd_boolean
1890 mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1891 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1892 {
1893 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1894 asection *s;
1895
1896 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1897 if (htab == NULL)
1898 return FALSE;
1899
1900 /* Create a trampoline section, if we haven't already. */
1901 s = htab->strampoline;
1902 if (s == NULL)
1903 {
1904 asection *input_section = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1905 s = htab->add_stub_section (".text", NULL,
1906 input_section->output_section);
1907 if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, 4))
1908 return FALSE;
1909 htab->strampoline = s;
1910 }
1911
1912 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1913 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 16);
1914 stub->stub_section = s;
1915 stub->offset = s->size;
1916
1917 /* Allocate room for it. */
1918 s->size += 16;
1919 return TRUE;
1920 }
1921
1922 /* H describes a symbol that needs an la25 stub. Make sure that an
1923 appropriate stub exists and point H at it. */
1924
1925 static bfd_boolean
1926 mips_elf_add_la25_stub (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1927 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1928 {
1929 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1930 struct mips_elf_la25_stub search, *stub;
1931 bfd_boolean use_trampoline_p;
1932 asection *s;
1933 bfd_vma value;
1934 void **slot;
1935
1936 /* Describe the stub we want. */
1937 search.stub_section = NULL;
1938 search.offset = 0;
1939 search.h = h;
1940
1941 /* See if we've already created an equivalent stub. */
1942 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1943 if (htab == NULL)
1944 return FALSE;
1945
1946 slot = htab_find_slot (htab->la25_stubs, &search, INSERT);
1947 if (slot == NULL)
1948 return FALSE;
1949
1950 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
1951 if (stub != NULL)
1952 {
1953 /* We can reuse the existing stub. */
1954 h->la25_stub = stub;
1955 return TRUE;
1956 }
1957
1958 /* Create a permanent copy of ENTRY and add it to the hash table. */
1959 stub = bfd_malloc (sizeof (search));
1960 if (stub == NULL)
1961 return FALSE;
1962 *stub = search;
1963 *slot = stub;
1964
1965 /* Prefer to use LUI/ADDIU stubs if the function is at the beginning
1966 of the section and if we would need no more than 2 nops. */
1967 value = mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &s);
1968 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
1969 value &= ~1;
1970 use_trampoline_p = (value != 0 || s->alignment_power > 4);
1971
1972 h->la25_stub = stub;
1973 return (use_trampoline_p
1974 ? mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (stub, info)
1975 : mips_elf_add_la25_intro (stub, info));
1976 }
1977
1978 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback that is called before sizing
1979 sections. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info structure. */
1980
1981 static bfd_boolean
1982 mips_elf_check_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1983 {
1984 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
1985
1986 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
1987 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (hti->info))
1988 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (hti->info, h);
1989
1990 if (mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (h))
1991 {
1992 /* PR 12845: If H is in a section that has been garbage
1993 collected it will have its output section set to *ABS*. */
1994 if (bfd_is_abs_section (h->root.root.u.def.section->output_section))
1995 return TRUE;
1996
1997 /* H is a function that might need $25 to be valid on entry.
1998 If we're creating a non-PIC relocatable object, mark H as
1999 being PIC. If we're creating a non-relocatable object with
2000 non-PIC branches and jumps to H, make sure that H has an la25
2001 stub. */
2002 if (bfd_link_relocatable (hti->info))
2003 {
2004 if (!PIC_OBJECT_P (hti->output_bfd))
2005 h->root.other = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other);
2006 }
2007 else if (h->has_nonpic_branches && !mips_elf_add_la25_stub (hti->info, h))
2008 {
2009 hti->error = TRUE;
2010 return FALSE;
2011 }
2012 }
2013 return TRUE;
2014 }
2015 \f
2016 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
2017 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
2018 are 32 bits.
2019
2020 The format of these instructions is:
2021
2022 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2023 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
2024 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2025 | Immediate 15:0 |
2026 +-----------------------------------------------+
2027
2028 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
2029 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
2030
2031 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
2032 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
2033 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
2034 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
2035 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
2036 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
2037 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
2038 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
2039 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
2040 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
2041 instruction.
2042
2043 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
2044 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
2045 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
2046 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
2047 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
2048 value as two 16-bit values.
2049
2050 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
2051 defined as
2052
2053 big-endian:
2054 +--------+----------------------+
2055 | | |
2056 | | targ26-16 |
2057 |31 26|25 0|
2058 +--------+----------------------+
2059
2060 little-endian:
2061 +----------+------+-------------+
2062 | | | |
2063 | sub1 | | sub2 |
2064 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
2065 +----------+--------------------+
2066 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
2067 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
2068
2069 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
2070 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
2071 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
2072 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
2073 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
2074
2075 The table below lists the other MIPS16 instruction relocations.
2076 Each one is calculated in the same way as the non-MIPS16 relocation
2077 given on the right, but using the extended MIPS16 layout of 16-bit
2078 immediate fields:
2079
2080 R_MIPS16_GPREL R_MIPS_GPREL16
2081 R_MIPS16_GOT16 R_MIPS_GOT16
2082 R_MIPS16_CALL16 R_MIPS_CALL16
2083 R_MIPS16_HI16 R_MIPS_HI16
2084 R_MIPS16_LO16 R_MIPS_LO16
2085
2086 A typical instruction will have a format like this:
2087
2088 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2089 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
2090 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2091 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
2092 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2093
2094 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
2095 opcode.
2096
2097 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately.
2098 As above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
2099 little-endian system.
2100
2101 Finally R_MIPS16_PC16_S1 corresponds to R_MIPS_PC16, however the
2102 relocatable field is shifted by 1 rather than 2 and the same bit
2103 shuffling is done as with the relocations above. */
2104
2105 static inline bfd_boolean
2106 mips16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2107 {
2108 switch (r_type)
2109 {
2110 case R_MIPS16_26:
2111 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
2112 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
2113 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
2114 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
2115 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
2116 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
2117 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
2118 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
2119 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
2120 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
2121 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
2122 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
2123 case R_MIPS16_PC16_S1:
2124 return TRUE;
2125
2126 default:
2127 return FALSE;
2128 }
2129 }
2130
2131 /* Check if a microMIPS reloc. */
2132
2133 static inline bfd_boolean
2134 micromips_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2135 {
2136 return r_type >= R_MICROMIPS_min && r_type < R_MICROMIPS_max;
2137 }
2138
2139 /* Similar to MIPS16, the two 16-bit halves in microMIPS must be swapped
2140 on a little-endian system. This does not apply to R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
2141 and R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1 relocs that apply to 16-bit instructions. */
2142
2143 static inline bfd_boolean
2144 micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (unsigned int r_type)
2145 {
2146 return (micromips_reloc_p (r_type)
2147 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
2148 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1);
2149 }
2150
2151 static inline bfd_boolean
2152 got16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2153 {
2154 return (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
2155 || r_type == R_MIPS16_GOT16
2156 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT16);
2157 }
2158
2159 static inline bfd_boolean
2160 call16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2161 {
2162 return (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16
2163 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16
2164 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL16);
2165 }
2166
2167 static inline bfd_boolean
2168 got_disp_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2169 {
2170 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP;
2171 }
2172
2173 static inline bfd_boolean
2174 got_page_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2175 {
2176 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE;
2177 }
2178
2179 static inline bfd_boolean
2180 got_lo16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2181 {
2182 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16;
2183 }
2184
2185 static inline bfd_boolean
2186 call_hi16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2187 {
2188 return r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16;
2189 }
2190
2191 static inline bfd_boolean
2192 call_lo16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2193 {
2194 return r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16;
2195 }
2196
2197 static inline bfd_boolean
2198 hi16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2199 {
2200 return (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
2201 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
2202 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16
2203 || r_type == R_MIPS_PCHI16);
2204 }
2205
2206 static inline bfd_boolean
2207 lo16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2208 {
2209 return (r_type == R_MIPS_LO16
2210 || r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16
2211 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
2212 || r_type == R_MIPS_PCLO16);
2213 }
2214
2215 static inline bfd_boolean
2216 mips16_call_reloc_p (int r_type)
2217 {
2218 return r_type == R_MIPS16_26 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16;
2219 }
2220
2221 static inline bfd_boolean
2222 jal_reloc_p (int r_type)
2223 {
2224 return (r_type == R_MIPS_26
2225 || r_type == R_MIPS16_26
2226 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1);
2227 }
2228
2229 static inline bfd_boolean
2230 b_reloc_p (int r_type)
2231 {
2232 return (r_type == R_MIPS_PC26_S2
2233 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC21_S2
2234 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC16
2235 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2
2236 || r_type == R_MIPS16_PC16_S1
2237 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
2238 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1
2239 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
2240 }
2241
2242 static inline bfd_boolean
2243 aligned_pcrel_reloc_p (int r_type)
2244 {
2245 return (r_type == R_MIPS_PC18_S3
2246 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC19_S2);
2247 }
2248
2249 static inline bfd_boolean
2250 branch_reloc_p (int r_type)
2251 {
2252 return (r_type == R_MIPS_26
2253 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC26_S2
2254 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC21_S2
2255 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC16
2256 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2);
2257 }
2258
2259 static inline bfd_boolean
2260 mips16_branch_reloc_p (int r_type)
2261 {
2262 return (r_type == R_MIPS16_26
2263 || r_type == R_MIPS16_PC16_S1);
2264 }
2265
2266 static inline bfd_boolean
2267 micromips_branch_reloc_p (int r_type)
2268 {
2269 return (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
2270 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
2271 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1
2272 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
2273 }
2274
2275 static inline bfd_boolean
2276 tls_gd_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2277 {
2278 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2279 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GD
2280 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD);
2281 }
2282
2283 static inline bfd_boolean
2284 tls_ldm_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2285 {
2286 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
2287 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM
2288 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM);
2289 }
2290
2291 static inline bfd_boolean
2292 tls_gottprel_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2293 {
2294 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL
2295 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL
2296 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL);
2297 }
2298
2299 void
2300 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
2301 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
2302 {
2303 bfd_vma first, second, val;
2304
2305 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type) && !micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (r_type))
2306 return;
2307
2308 /* Pick up the first and second halfwords of the instruction. */
2309 first = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
2310 second = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
2311 if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type) || (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
2312 val = first << 16 | second;
2313 else if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26)
2314 val = (((first & 0xf800) << 16) | ((second & 0xffe0) << 11)
2315 | ((first & 0x1f) << 11) | (first & 0x7e0) | (second & 0x1f));
2316 else
2317 val = (((first & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((first & 0x3e0) << 11)
2318 | ((first & 0x1f) << 21) | second);
2319 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
2320 }
2321
2322 void
2323 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
2324 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
2325 {
2326 bfd_vma first, second, val;
2327
2328 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type) && !micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (r_type))
2329 return;
2330
2331 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
2332 if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type) || (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
2333 {
2334 second = val & 0xffff;
2335 first = val >> 16;
2336 }
2337 else if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26)
2338 {
2339 second = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
2340 first = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
2341 }
2342 else
2343 {
2344 second = val & 0xffff;
2345 first = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
2346 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
2347 }
2348 bfd_put_16 (abfd, second, data + 2);
2349 bfd_put_16 (abfd, first, data);
2350 }
2351
2352 bfd_reloc_status_type
2353 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
2354 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
2355 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
2356 {
2357 bfd_vma relocation;
2358 bfd_signed_vma val;
2359 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
2360
2361 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2362 relocation = 0;
2363 else
2364 relocation = symbol->value;
2365
2366 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
2367 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
2368
2369 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2370 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2371
2372 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
2373 val = reloc_entry->addend;
2374
2375 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
2376
2377 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
2378 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
2379 an external symbol. */
2380 if (! relocatable
2381 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
2382 val += relocation - gp;
2383
2384 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
2385 {
2386 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
2387 (bfd_byte *) data
2388 + reloc_entry->address);
2389 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
2390 return status;
2391 }
2392 else
2393 reloc_entry->addend = val;
2394
2395 if (relocatable)
2396 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2397
2398 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2399 }
2400
2401 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
2402 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
2403 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
2404 INPUT_SECTION. */
2405
2406 struct mips_hi16
2407 {
2408 struct mips_hi16 *next;
2409 bfd_byte *data;
2410 asection *input_section;
2411 arelent rel;
2412 };
2413
2414 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
2415
2416 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
2417
2418 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
2419 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
2420 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
2421
2422 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
2423 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
2424 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
2425 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
2426
2427 bfd_reloc_status_type
2428 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2429 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
2430 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2431 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2432 {
2433 struct mips_hi16 *n;
2434
2435 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2436 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2437
2438 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
2439 if (n == NULL)
2440 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2441
2442 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
2443 n->data = data;
2444 n->input_section = input_section;
2445 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
2446 mips_hi16_list = n;
2447
2448 if (output_bfd != NULL)
2449 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2450
2451 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2452 }
2453
2454 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations. This is just
2455 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
2456 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
2457
2458 bfd_reloc_status_type
2459 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2460 void *data, asection *input_section,
2461 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2462 {
2463 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
2464 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
2465 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
2466 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
2467 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2468 input_section, output_bfd,
2469 error_message);
2470
2471 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2472 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
2473 }
2474
2475 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
2476 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
2477 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
2478
2479 bfd_reloc_status_type
2480 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2481 void *data, asection *input_section,
2482 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2483 {
2484 bfd_vma vallo;
2485 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2486
2487 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2488 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2489
2490 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2491 location);
2492 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
2493 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2494 location);
2495
2496 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
2497 {
2498 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
2499 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
2500
2501 hi = mips_hi16_list;
2502
2503 /* R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
2504 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS*_HI16
2505 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
2506 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
2507 has a rightshift of 0. */
2508 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
2509 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
2510 else if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS16_GOT16)
2511 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS16_HI16, FALSE);
2512 else if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT16)
2513 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MICROMIPS_HI16, FALSE);
2514
2515 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
2516 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
2517 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
2518
2519 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
2520 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
2521 error_message);
2522 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
2523 return ret;
2524
2525 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
2526 free (hi);
2527 }
2528
2529 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2530 input_section, output_bfd,
2531 error_message);
2532 }
2533
2534 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
2535 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
2536 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
2537
2538 bfd_reloc_status_type
2539 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2540 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2541 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2542 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2543 {
2544 bfd_signed_vma val;
2545 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
2546 bfd_boolean relocatable;
2547
2548 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
2549
2550 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2551 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2552
2553 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
2554 val = 0;
2555 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
2556 {
2557 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
2558 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
2559 offset or address. */
2560 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
2561 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
2562 }
2563
2564 if (!relocatable)
2565 {
2566 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
2567 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
2568 val += symbol->value;
2569 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
2570 {
2571 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
2572 val -= input_section->output_offset;
2573 val -= reloc_entry->address;
2574 }
2575 }
2576
2577 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
2578 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
2579 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
2580 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
2581 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
2582 reloc_entry->addend += val;
2583 else
2584 {
2585 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2586
2587 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
2588 val += reloc_entry->addend;
2589
2590 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
2591 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2592 location);
2593 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
2594 location);
2595 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2596 location);
2597
2598 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
2599 return status;
2600 }
2601
2602 if (relocatable)
2603 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2604
2605 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2606 }
2607 \f
2608 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
2609 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
2610
2611 static void
2612 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
2613 Elf32_gptab *in)
2614 {
2615 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2616 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2617 }
2618
2619 static void
2620 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
2621 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
2622 {
2623 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2624 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2625 }
2626
2627 static void
2628 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
2629 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
2630 {
2631 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
2632 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
2633 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
2634 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
2635 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
2636 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
2637 }
2638
2639 static void
2640 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
2641 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
2642 {
2643 unsigned long l;
2644
2645 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
2646 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
2647 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
2648 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
2649 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
2650 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
2651 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
2652 }
2653 \f
2654 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
2655 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
2656 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
2657
2658 void
2659 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
2660 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
2661 {
2662 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2663 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2664 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2665 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2666 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2667 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2668 }
2669
2670 void
2671 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
2672 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
2673 {
2674 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2675 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2676 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2677 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2678 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2679 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2680 }
2681
2682 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
2683 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
2684 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
2685 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
2686 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
2687
2688 void
2689 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
2690 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
2691 {
2692 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2693 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
2694 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2695 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2696 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2697 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2698 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2699 }
2700
2701 void
2702 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
2703 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
2704 {
2705 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2706 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
2707 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2708 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2709 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2710 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2711 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2712 }
2713
2714 /* Swap in an options header. */
2715
2716 void
2717 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
2718 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
2719 {
2720 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
2721 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
2722 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
2723 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
2724 }
2725
2726 /* Swap out an options header. */
2727
2728 void
2729 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
2730 Elf_External_Options *ex)
2731 {
2732 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
2733 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
2734 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
2735 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
2736 }
2737
2738 /* Swap in an abiflags structure. */
2739
2740 void
2741 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_in (bfd *abfd,
2742 const Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 *ex,
2743 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *in)
2744 {
2745 in->version = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->version);
2746 in->isa_level = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->isa_level);
2747 in->isa_rev = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->isa_rev);
2748 in->gpr_size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->gpr_size);
2749 in->cpr1_size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->cpr1_size);
2750 in->cpr2_size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->cpr2_size);
2751 in->fp_abi = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->fp_abi);
2752 in->isa_ext = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->isa_ext);
2753 in->ases = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ases);
2754 in->flags1 = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->flags1);
2755 in->flags2 = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->flags2);
2756 }
2757
2758 /* Swap out an abiflags structure. */
2759
2760 void
2761 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_out (bfd *abfd,
2762 const Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *in,
2763 Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 *ex)
2764 {
2765 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->version, ex->version);
2766 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->isa_level, ex->isa_level);
2767 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->isa_rev, ex->isa_rev);
2768 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->gpr_size, ex->gpr_size);
2769 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->cpr1_size, ex->cpr1_size);
2770 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->cpr2_size, ex->cpr2_size);
2771 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->fp_abi, ex->fp_abi);
2772 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->isa_ext, ex->isa_ext);
2773 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ases, ex->ases);
2774 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->flags1, ex->flags1);
2775 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->flags2, ex->flags2);
2776 }
2777 \f
2778 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
2779 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
2780
2781 static int
2782 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
2783 {
2784 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
2785 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
2786 int diff;
2787
2788 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
2789 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
2790
2791 diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
2792 if (diff != 0)
2793 return diff;
2794
2795 if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
2796 return -1;
2797 if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
2798 return 1;
2799 return 0;
2800 }
2801
2802 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
2803
2804 static int
2805 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2806 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2807 {
2808 #ifdef BFD64
2809 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
2810 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
2811
2812 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2813 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
2814 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2815 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
2816
2817 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2818 return -1;
2819 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2820 return 1;
2821
2822 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2823 return -1;
2824 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2825 return 1;
2826 return 0;
2827 #else
2828 abort ();
2829 #endif
2830 }
2831
2832
2833 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
2834 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
2835 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
2836 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
2837 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
2838 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
2839 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
2840 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
2841 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
2842 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
2843 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
2844 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
2845 when generating a final executable. */
2846
2847 static bfd_boolean
2848 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2849 {
2850 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
2851 bfd_boolean strip;
2852 asection *sec, *output_section;
2853
2854 if (h->root.indx == -2)
2855 strip = FALSE;
2856 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
2857 || h->root.ref_dynamic
2858 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
2859 && !h->root.def_regular
2860 && !h->root.ref_regular)
2861 strip = TRUE;
2862 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
2863 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
2864 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
2865 h->root.root.root.string,
2866 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
2867 strip = TRUE;
2868 else
2869 strip = FALSE;
2870
2871 if (strip)
2872 return TRUE;
2873
2874 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
2875 {
2876 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
2877 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
2878 h->esym.weakext = 0;
2879 h->esym.reserved = 0;
2880 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
2881 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2882 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
2883
2884 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
2885 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
2886 {
2887 const char *name;
2888
2889 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
2890 special symbols. */
2891 name = h->root.root.root.string;
2892 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
2893 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
2894 {
2895 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
2896 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2897 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2898 }
2899 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
2900 {
2901 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2902 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2903 h->esym.asym.value =
2904 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
2905 }
2906 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
2907 {
2908 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2909 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2910 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
2911 }
2912 else
2913 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2914 }
2915 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
2916 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2917 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2918 else
2919 {
2920 const char *name;
2921
2922 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
2923 output_section = sec->output_section;
2924
2925 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
2926 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
2927 if (output_section == NULL)
2928 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2929 else
2930 {
2931 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
2932
2933 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
2934 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
2935 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
2936 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
2937 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
2938 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
2939 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
2940 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
2941 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
2942 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
2943 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
2944 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
2945 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
2946 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
2947 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
2948 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
2949 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
2950 else
2951 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2952 }
2953 }
2954
2955 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
2956 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
2957 }
2958
2959 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
2960 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
2961 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2962 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2963 {
2964 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
2965 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
2966 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
2967 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
2968
2969 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
2970 output_section = sec->output_section;
2971 if (output_section != NULL)
2972 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
2973 + sec->output_offset
2974 + output_section->vma);
2975 else
2976 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2977 }
2978 else
2979 {
2980 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
2981
2982 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2983 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
2984
2985 if (hd->needs_lazy_stub)
2986 {
2987 BFD_ASSERT (hd->root.plt.plist != NULL);
2988 BFD_ASSERT (hd->root.plt.plist->stub_offset != MINUS_ONE);
2989 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
2990 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
2991 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
2992 if (sec == NULL)
2993 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2994 else
2995 {
2996 output_section = sec->output_section;
2997 if (output_section != NULL)
2998 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.plist->stub_offset
2999 + sec->output_offset
3000 + output_section->vma);
3001 else
3002 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
3003 }
3004 }
3005 }
3006
3007 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
3008 h->root.root.root.string,
3009 &h->esym))
3010 {
3011 einfo->failed = TRUE;
3012 return FALSE;
3013 }
3014
3015 return TRUE;
3016 }
3017
3018 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
3019
3020 static int
3021 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
3022 {
3023 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
3024 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
3025
3026 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
3027 }
3028 \f
3029 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
3030
3031 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
3032 hash number. */
3033
3034 static INLINE hashval_t
3035 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
3036 {
3037 #ifdef BFD64
3038 return addr + (addr >> 32);
3039 #else
3040 return addr;
3041 #endif
3042 }
3043
3044 static hashval_t
3045 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
3046 {
3047 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
3048
3049 return (entry->symndx
3050 + ((entry->tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM) << 18)
3051 + (entry->tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM ? 0
3052 : !entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
3053 : entry->symndx >= 0 ? (entry->abfd->id
3054 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend))
3055 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
3056 }
3057
3058 static int
3059 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
3060 {
3061 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
3062 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
3063
3064 return (e1->symndx == e2->symndx
3065 && e1->tls_type == e2->tls_type
3066 && (e1->tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM ? TRUE
3067 : !e1->abfd ? !e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
3068 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? (e1->abfd == e2->abfd
3069 && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend)
3070 : e2->abfd && e1->d.h == e2->d.h));
3071 }
3072
3073 static hashval_t
3074 mips_got_page_ref_hash (const void *ref_)
3075 {
3076 const struct mips_got_page_ref *ref;
3077
3078 ref = (const struct mips_got_page_ref *) ref_;
3079 return ((ref->symndx >= 0
3080 ? (hashval_t) (ref->u.abfd->id + ref->symndx)
3081 : ref->u.h->root.root.root.hash)
3082 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (ref->addend));
3083 }
3084
3085 static int
3086 mips_got_page_ref_eq (const void *ref1_, const void *ref2_)
3087 {
3088 const struct mips_got_page_ref *ref1, *ref2;
3089
3090 ref1 = (const struct mips_got_page_ref *) ref1_;
3091 ref2 = (const struct mips_got_page_ref *) ref2_;
3092 return (ref1->symndx == ref2->symndx
3093 && (ref1->symndx < 0
3094 ? ref1->u.h == ref2->u.h
3095 : ref1->u.abfd == ref2->u.abfd)
3096 && ref1->addend == ref2->addend);
3097 }
3098
3099 static hashval_t
3100 mips_got_page_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
3101 {
3102 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry;
3103
3104 entry = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry_;
3105 return entry->sec->id;
3106 }
3107
3108 static int
3109 mips_got_page_entry_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
3110 {
3111 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry1, *entry2;
3112
3113 entry1 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry1_;
3114 entry2 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry2_;
3115 return entry1->sec == entry2->sec;
3116 }
3117 \f
3118 /* Create and return a new mips_got_info structure. */
3119
3120 static struct mips_got_info *
3121 mips_elf_create_got_info (bfd *abfd)
3122 {
3123 struct mips_got_info *g;
3124
3125 g = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3126 if (g == NULL)
3127 return NULL;
3128
3129 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3130 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3131 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3132 return NULL;
3133
3134 g->got_page_refs = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_ref_hash,
3135 mips_got_page_ref_eq, NULL);
3136 if (g->got_page_refs == NULL)
3137 return NULL;
3138
3139 return g;
3140 }
3141
3142 /* Return the GOT info for input bfd ABFD, trying to create a new one if
3143 CREATE_P and if ABFD doesn't already have a GOT. */
3144
3145 static struct mips_got_info *
3146 mips_elf_bfd_got (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean create_p)
3147 {
3148 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *tdata;
3149
3150 if (!is_mips_elf (abfd))
3151 return NULL;
3152
3153 tdata = mips_elf_tdata (abfd);
3154 if (!tdata->got && create_p)
3155 tdata->got = mips_elf_create_got_info (abfd);
3156 return tdata->got;
3157 }
3158
3159 /* Record that ABFD should use output GOT G. */
3160
3161 static void
3162 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g)
3163 {
3164 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *tdata;
3165
3166 BFD_ASSERT (is_mips_elf (abfd));
3167 tdata = mips_elf_tdata (abfd);
3168 if (tdata->got)
3169 {
3170 /* The GOT structure itself and the hash table entries are
3171 allocated to a bfd, but the hash tables aren't. */
3172 htab_delete (tdata->got->got_entries);
3173 htab_delete (tdata->got->got_page_refs);
3174 if (tdata->got->got_page_entries)
3175 htab_delete (tdata->got->got_page_entries);
3176 }
3177 tdata->got = g;
3178 }
3179
3180 /* Return the dynamic relocation section. If it doesn't exist, try to
3181 create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL. Also return NULL
3182 if creation fails. */
3183
3184 static asection *
3185 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
3186 {
3187 const char *dname;
3188 asection *sreloc;
3189 bfd *dynobj;
3190
3191 dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
3192 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3193 sreloc = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, dname);
3194 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
3195 {
3196 sreloc = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
3197 (SEC_ALLOC
3198 | SEC_LOAD
3199 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3200 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3201 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3202 | SEC_READONLY));
3203 if (sreloc == NULL
3204 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
3205 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
3206 return NULL;
3207 }
3208 return sreloc;
3209 }
3210
3211 /* Return the GOT_TLS_* type required by relocation type R_TYPE. */
3212
3213 static int
3214 mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (unsigned int r_type)
3215 {
3216 if (tls_gd_reloc_p (r_type))
3217 return GOT_TLS_GD;
3218
3219 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
3220 return GOT_TLS_LDM;
3221
3222 if (tls_gottprel_reloc_p (r_type))
3223 return GOT_TLS_IE;
3224
3225 return GOT_TLS_NONE;
3226 }
3227
3228 /* Return the number of GOT slots needed for GOT TLS type TYPE. */
3229
3230 static int
3231 mips_tls_got_entries (unsigned int type)
3232 {
3233 switch (type)
3234 {
3235 case GOT_TLS_GD:
3236 case GOT_TLS_LDM:
3237 return 2;
3238
3239 case GOT_TLS_IE:
3240 return 1;
3241
3242 case GOT_TLS_NONE:
3243 return 0;
3244 }
3245 abort ();
3246 }
3247
3248 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
3249 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
3250 is NULL). */
3251
3252 static int
3253 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
3254 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3255 {
3256 int indx = 0;
3257 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
3258 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
3259
3260 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, bfd_link_pic (info), h)
3261 && (!bfd_link_pic (info) || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
3262 indx = h->dynindx;
3263
3264 if ((bfd_link_pic (info) || indx != 0)
3265 && (h == NULL
3266 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
3267 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
3268 need_relocs = TRUE;
3269
3270 if (!need_relocs)
3271 return 0;
3272
3273 switch (tls_type)
3274 {
3275 case GOT_TLS_GD:
3276 return indx != 0 ? 2 : 1;
3277
3278 case GOT_TLS_IE:
3279 return 1;
3280
3281 case GOT_TLS_LDM:
3282 return bfd_link_pic (info) ? 1 : 0;
3283
3284 default:
3285 return 0;
3286 }
3287 }
3288
3289 /* Add the number of GOT entries and TLS relocations required by ENTRY
3290 to G. */
3291
3292 static void
3293 mips_elf_count_got_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3294 struct mips_got_info *g,
3295 struct mips_got_entry *entry)
3296 {
3297 if (entry->tls_type)
3298 {
3299 g->tls_gotno += mips_tls_got_entries (entry->tls_type);
3300 g->relocs += mips_tls_got_relocs (info, entry->tls_type,
3301 entry->symndx < 0
3302 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3303 }
3304 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE)
3305 g->local_gotno += 1;
3306 else
3307 g->global_gotno += 1;
3308 }
3309
3310 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
3311
3312 static void
3313 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
3314 asection *sreloc,
3315 unsigned long reloc_index,
3316 unsigned long indx,
3317 int r_type,
3318 bfd_vma offset)
3319 {
3320 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
3321
3322 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
3323
3324 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
3325 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
3326
3327 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
3328 {
3329 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
3330 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
3331 (sreloc->contents
3332 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
3333 }
3334 else
3335 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
3336 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
3337 (sreloc->contents
3338 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
3339 }
3340
3341 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
3342
3343 static void
3344 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3345 struct mips_got_entry *entry,
3346 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3347 bfd_vma value)
3348 {
3349 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3350 int indx;
3351 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
3352 bfd_vma got_offset, got_offset2;
3353 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
3354
3355 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3356 if (htab == NULL)
3357 return;
3358
3359 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
3360
3361 indx = 0;
3362 if (h != NULL)
3363 {
3364 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
3365
3366 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, bfd_link_pic (info),
3367 &h->root)
3368 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
3369 || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
3370 indx = h->root.dynindx;
3371 }
3372
3373 if (entry->tls_initialized)
3374 return;
3375
3376 if ((bfd_link_pic (info) || indx != 0)
3377 && (h == NULL
3378 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
3379 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
3380 need_relocs = TRUE;
3381
3382 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
3383 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
3384 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
3385 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
3386 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
3387
3388 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
3389 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3390 got_offset = entry->gotidx;
3391
3392 switch (entry->tls_type)
3393 {
3394 case GOT_TLS_GD:
3395 /* General Dynamic. */
3396 got_offset2 = got_offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3397
3398 if (need_relocs)
3399 {
3400 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3401 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3402 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
3403 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
3404
3405 if (indx)
3406 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3407 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3408 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
3409 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset2);
3410 else
3411 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
3412 sgot->contents + got_offset2);
3413 }
3414 else
3415 {
3416 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
3417 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3418 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
3419 sgot->contents + got_offset2);
3420 }
3421 break;
3422
3423 case GOT_TLS_IE:
3424 /* Initial Exec model. */
3425 if (need_relocs)
3426 {
3427 if (indx == 0)
3428 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
3429 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3430 else
3431 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
3432 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3433
3434 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3435 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3436 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
3437 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
3438 }
3439 else
3440 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
3441 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3442 break;
3443
3444 case GOT_TLS_LDM:
3445 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
3446 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
3447 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
3448 sgot->contents + got_offset
3449 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
3450
3451 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
3452 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
3453 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3454 else
3455 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3456 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3457 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
3458 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
3459 break;
3460
3461 default:
3462 abort ();
3463 }
3464
3465 entry->tls_initialized = TRUE;
3466 }
3467
3468 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
3469 for global symbol H. .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
3470 will be negative. */
3471
3472 static bfd_vma
3473 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3474 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3475 {
3476 bfd_vma got_address, got_value;
3477 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3478
3479 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3480 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3481
3482 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.plist != NULL);
3483 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.plist->gotplt_index != MINUS_ONE);
3484
3485 /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry. */
3486 got_address = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
3487 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset
3488 + (h->plt.plist->gotplt_index
3489 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (info->output_bfd)));
3490
3491 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
3492 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
3493 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3494 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
3495
3496 return got_address - got_value;
3497 }
3498
3499 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE. If there is not yet a GOT
3500 entry for this value, create one. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
3501 create a TLS GOT entry instead. Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
3502 offset can be found. */
3503
3504 static bfd_vma
3505 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3506 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
3507 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
3508 {
3509 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3510 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3511
3512 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3513 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3514
3515 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value,
3516 r_symndx, h, r_type);
3517 if (!entry)
3518 return MINUS_ONE;
3519
3520 if (entry->tls_type)
3521 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, info, entry, h, value);
3522 return entry->gotidx;
3523 }
3524
3525 /* Return the GOT index of global symbol H in the primary GOT. */
3526
3527 static bfd_vma
3528 mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3529 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3530 {
3531 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3532 long global_got_dynindx;
3533 struct mips_got_info *g;
3534 bfd_vma got_index;
3535
3536 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3537 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3538
3539 global_got_dynindx = 0;
3540 if (htab->global_gotsym != NULL)
3541 global_got_dynindx = htab->global_gotsym->dynindx;
3542
3543 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
3544 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
3545 indices into the primary GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the
3546 GOT offset. */
3547 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
3548 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (obfd, FALSE);
3549 got_index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
3550 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (obfd));
3551 BFD_ASSERT (got_index < htab->root.sgot->size);
3552
3553 return got_index;
3554 }
3555
3556 /* Return the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H, which is
3557 referenced by a relocation of type R_TYPE in IBFD. */
3558
3559 static bfd_vma
3560 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *ibfd,
3561 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
3562 {
3563 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3564 struct mips_got_info *g;
3565 struct mips_got_entry lookup, *entry;
3566 bfd_vma gotidx;
3567
3568 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3569 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3570
3571 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
3572 BFD_ASSERT (g);
3573
3574 lookup.tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
3575 if (!lookup.tls_type && g == mips_elf_bfd_got (obfd, FALSE))
3576 return mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (obfd, info, h);
3577
3578 lookup.abfd = ibfd;
3579 lookup.symndx = -1;
3580 lookup.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3581 entry = htab_find (g->got_entries, &lookup);
3582 BFD_ASSERT (entry);
3583
3584 gotidx = entry->gotidx;
3585 BFD_ASSERT (gotidx > 0 && gotidx < htab->root.sgot->size);
3586
3587 if (lookup.tls_type)
3588 {
3589 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
3590
3591 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3592 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3593 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
3594 value = (h->root.u.def.value
3595 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3596 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
3597
3598 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (obfd, info, entry, lookup.d.h, value);
3599 }
3600 return gotidx;
3601 }
3602
3603 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE. These
3604 entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
3605 within 32KB of GP. Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
3606 entry could be created. If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
3607 offset of the GOT entry from VALUE. */
3608
3609 static bfd_vma
3610 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3611 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
3612 {
3613 bfd_vma page, got_index;
3614 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3615
3616 page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
3617 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, page, 0,
3618 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
3619
3620 if (!entry)
3621 return MINUS_ONE;
3622
3623 got_index = entry->gotidx;
3624
3625 if (offsetp)
3626 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
3627
3628 return got_index;
3629 }
3630
3631 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
3632 EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was originally against a global
3633 symbol that binds locally. */
3634
3635 static bfd_vma
3636 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3637 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
3638 {
3639 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3640
3641 /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
3642 relocation; those against global symbols are not. Thus if the
3643 symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
3644 equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself. */
3645 if (! external)
3646 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
3647
3648 /* It doesn't matter whether the original relocation was R_MIPS_GOT16,
3649 R_MIPS16_GOT16, R_MIPS_CALL16, etc. The format of the entry is the
3650 same in all cases. */
3651 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value, 0,
3652 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
3653 if (entry)
3654 return entry->gotidx;
3655 else
3656 return MINUS_ONE;
3657 }
3658
3659 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
3660 in the GOT. */
3661
3662 static bfd_vma
3663 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *output_bfd,
3664 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma got_index)
3665 {
3666 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3667 asection *sgot;
3668 bfd_vma gp;
3669
3670 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3671 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3672
3673 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
3674 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
3675 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
3676
3677 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + got_index - gp;
3678 }
3679
3680 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
3681 from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON. Return NULL if it could not
3682 be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
3683 instead. */
3684
3685 static struct mips_got_entry *
3686 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3687 bfd *ibfd, bfd_vma value,
3688 unsigned long r_symndx,
3689 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3690 int r_type)
3691 {
3692 struct mips_got_entry lookup, *entry;
3693 void **loc;
3694 struct mips_got_info *g;
3695 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3696 bfd_vma gotidx;
3697
3698 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3699 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3700
3701 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
3702 if (g == NULL)
3703 {
3704 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (abfd, FALSE);
3705 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3706 }
3707
3708 /* This function shouldn't be called for symbols that live in the global
3709 area of the GOT. */
3710 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
3711
3712 lookup.tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
3713 if (lookup.tls_type)
3714 {
3715 lookup.abfd = ibfd;
3716 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
3717 {
3718 lookup.symndx = 0;
3719 lookup.d.addend = 0;
3720 }
3721 else if (h == NULL)
3722 {
3723 lookup.symndx = r_symndx;
3724 lookup.d.addend = 0;
3725 }
3726 else
3727 {
3728 lookup.symndx = -1;
3729 lookup.d.h = h;
3730 }
3731
3732 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries, &lookup);
3733 BFD_ASSERT (entry);
3734
3735 gotidx = entry->gotidx;
3736 BFD_ASSERT (gotidx > 0 && gotidx < htab->root.sgot->size);
3737
3738 return entry;
3739 }
3740
3741 lookup.abfd = NULL;
3742 lookup.symndx = -1;
3743 lookup.d.address = value;
3744 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &lookup, INSERT);
3745 if (!loc)
3746 return NULL;
3747
3748 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *loc;
3749 if (entry)
3750 return entry;
3751
3752 if (g->assigned_low_gotno > g->assigned_high_gotno)
3753 {
3754 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
3755 _bfd_error_handler
3756 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
3757 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3758 return NULL;
3759 }
3760
3761 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3762 if (!entry)
3763 return NULL;
3764
3765 if (got16_reloc_p (r_type)
3766 || call16_reloc_p (r_type)
3767 || got_page_reloc_p (r_type)
3768 || got_disp_reloc_p (r_type))
3769 lookup.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_low_gotno++;
3770 else
3771 lookup.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_high_gotno--;
3772
3773 *entry = lookup;
3774 *loc = entry;
3775
3776 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value, htab->root.sgot->contents + entry->gotidx);
3777
3778 /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks. */
3779 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3780 {
3781 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
3782 asection *s;
3783 bfd_byte *rloc;
3784 bfd_vma got_address;
3785
3786 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3787 got_address = (htab->root.sgot->output_section->vma
3788 + htab->root.sgot->output_offset
3789 + entry->gotidx);
3790
3791 rloc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
3792 outrel.r_offset = got_address;
3793 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
3794 outrel.r_addend = value;
3795 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, rloc);
3796 }
3797
3798 return entry;
3799 }
3800
3801 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
3802 The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
3803 much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
3804 the current linking stage. */
3805
3806 static bfd_size_type
3807 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3808 {
3809 bfd_size_type count;
3810
3811 count = 0;
3812 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3813 || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
3814 {
3815 asection *p;
3816 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3817
3818 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
3819 for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
3820 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3821 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3822 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
3823 ++count;
3824 }
3825 return count;
3826 }
3827
3828 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
3829 appear towards the end. */
3830
3831 static bfd_boolean
3832 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3833 {
3834 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3835 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
3836 struct mips_got_info *g;
3837
3838 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3839 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3840
3841 if (htab->root.dynsymcount == 0)
3842 return TRUE;
3843
3844 g = htab->got_info;
3845 if (g == NULL)
3846 return TRUE;
3847
3848 hsd.low = NULL;
3849 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
3850 = hsd.min_got_dynindx
3851 = (htab->root.dynsymcount - g->reloc_only_gotno);
3852 /* Add 1 to local symbol indices to account for the mandatory NULL entry
3853 at the head of the table; see `_bfd_elf_link_renumber_dynsyms'. */
3854 hsd.max_local_dynindx = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info) + 1;
3855 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = htab->root.local_dynsymcount + 1;
3856 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f, &hsd);
3857
3858 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
3859 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
3860 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_local_dynindx <= htab->root.local_dynsymcount + 1);
3861 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
3862 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx == htab->root.dynsymcount);
3863 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.dynsymcount - hsd.min_got_dynindx == g->global_gotno);
3864
3865 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
3866 table index in the GOT. */
3867 htab->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
3868
3869 return TRUE;
3870 }
3871
3872 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
3873 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
3874 index. */
3875
3876 static bfd_boolean
3877 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
3878 {
3879 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
3880
3881 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
3882 at all. */
3883 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
3884 return TRUE;
3885
3886 switch (h->global_got_area)
3887 {
3888 case GGA_NONE:
3889 if (h->root.forced_local)
3890 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_local_dynindx++;
3891 else
3892 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
3893 break;
3894
3895 case GGA_NORMAL:
3896 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
3897 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3898 break;
3899
3900 case GGA_RELOC_ONLY:
3901 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
3902 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3903 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
3904 break;
3905 }
3906
3907 return TRUE;
3908 }
3909
3910 /* Record that input bfd ABFD requires a GOT entry like *LOOKUP
3911 (which is owned by the caller and shouldn't be added to the
3912 hash table directly). */
3913
3914 static bfd_boolean
3915 mips_elf_record_got_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *abfd,
3916 struct mips_got_entry *lookup)
3917 {
3918 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3919 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3920 struct mips_got_info *g;
3921 void **loc, **bfd_loc;
3922
3923 /* Make sure there's a slot for this entry in the master GOT. */
3924 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3925 g = htab->got_info;
3926 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, lookup, INSERT);
3927 if (!loc)
3928 return FALSE;
3929
3930 /* Populate the entry if it isn't already. */
3931 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *loc;
3932 if (!entry)
3933 {
3934 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3935 if (!entry)
3936 return FALSE;
3937
3938 lookup->tls_initialized = FALSE;
3939 lookup->gotidx = -1;
3940 *entry = *lookup;
3941 *loc = entry;
3942 }
3943
3944 /* Reuse the same GOT entry for the BFD's GOT. */
3945 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (abfd, TRUE);
3946 if (!g)
3947 return FALSE;
3948
3949 bfd_loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, lookup, INSERT);
3950 if (!bfd_loc)
3951 return FALSE;
3952
3953 if (!*bfd_loc)
3954 *bfd_loc = entry;
3955 return TRUE;
3956 }
3957
3958 /* ABFD has a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against H. Reserve a GOT
3959 entry for it. FOR_CALL is true if the caller is only interested in
3960 using the GOT entry for calls. */
3961
3962 static bfd_boolean
3963 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3964 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3965 bfd_boolean for_call, int r_type)
3966 {
3967 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3968 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
3969 struct mips_got_entry entry;
3970 unsigned char tls_type;
3971
3972 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3973 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3974
3975 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3976 if (!for_call)
3977 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
3978
3979 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
3980 table. */
3981 if (h->dynindx == -1)
3982 {
3983 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
3984 {
3985 case STV_INTERNAL:
3986 case STV_HIDDEN:
3987 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
3988 break;
3989 }
3990 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3991 return FALSE;
3992 }
3993
3994 tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
3995 if (tls_type == GOT_TLS_NONE && hmips->global_got_area > GGA_NORMAL)
3996 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_NORMAL;
3997
3998 entry.abfd = abfd;
3999 entry.symndx = -1;
4000 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
4001 entry.tls_type = tls_type;
4002 return mips_elf_record_got_entry (info, abfd, &entry);
4003 }
4004
4005 /* ABFD has a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against symbol SYMNDX + ADDEND,
4006 where SYMNDX is a local symbol. Reserve a GOT entry for it. */
4007
4008 static bfd_boolean
4009 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
4010 struct bfd_link_info *info, int r_type)
4011 {
4012 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4013 struct mips_got_info *g;
4014 struct mips_got_entry entry;
4015
4016 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4017 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4018
4019 g = htab->got_info;
4020 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
4021
4022 entry.abfd = abfd;
4023 entry.symndx = symndx;
4024 entry.d.addend = addend;
4025 entry.tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
4026 return mips_elf_record_got_entry (info, abfd, &entry);
4027 }
4028
4029 /* Record that ABFD has a page relocation against SYMNDX + ADDEND.
4030 H is the symbol's hash table entry, or null if SYMNDX is local
4031 to ABFD. */
4032
4033 static bfd_boolean
4034 mips_elf_record_got_page_ref (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *abfd,
4035 long symndx, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4036 bfd_signed_vma addend)
4037 {
4038 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4039 struct mips_got_info *g1, *g2;
4040 struct mips_got_page_ref lookup, *entry;
4041 void **loc, **bfd_loc;
4042
4043 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4044 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4045
4046 g1 = htab->got_info;
4047 BFD_ASSERT (g1 != NULL);
4048
4049 if (h)
4050 {
4051 lookup.symndx = -1;
4052 lookup.u.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
4053 }
4054 else
4055 {
4056 lookup.symndx = symndx;
4057 lookup.u.abfd = abfd;
4058 }
4059 lookup.addend = addend;
4060 loc = htab_find_slot (g1->got_page_refs, &lookup, INSERT);
4061 if (loc == NULL)
4062 return FALSE;
4063
4064 entry = (struct mips_got_page_ref *) *loc;
4065 if (!entry)
4066 {
4067 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
4068 if (!entry)
4069 return FALSE;
4070
4071 *entry = lookup;
4072 *loc = entry;
4073 }
4074
4075 /* Add the same entry to the BFD's GOT. */
4076 g2 = mips_elf_bfd_got (abfd, TRUE);
4077 if (!g2)
4078 return FALSE;
4079
4080 bfd_loc = htab_find_slot (g2->got_page_refs, &lookup, INSERT);
4081 if (!bfd_loc)
4082 return FALSE;
4083
4084 if (!*bfd_loc)
4085 *bfd_loc = entry;
4086
4087 return TRUE;
4088 }
4089
4090 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD. */
4091
4092 static void
4093 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4094 unsigned int n)
4095 {
4096 asection *s;
4097 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4098
4099 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4100 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4101
4102 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4103 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4104
4105 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4106 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
4107 else
4108 {
4109 if (s->size == 0)
4110 {
4111 /* Make room for a null element. */
4112 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4113 ++s->reloc_count;
4114 }
4115 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4116 }
4117 }
4118 \f
4119 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries, with DATA pointing to a
4120 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg structure. Count the number of GOT
4121 entries and TLS relocs. Set DATA->value to true if we need
4122 to resolve indirect or warning symbols and then recreate the GOT. */
4123
4124 static int
4125 mips_elf_check_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
4126 {
4127 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4128 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4129
4130 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4131 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4132 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
4133 {
4134 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4135
4136 h = entry->d.h;
4137 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4138 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4139 {
4140 arg->value = TRUE;
4141 return 0;
4142 }
4143 }
4144 mips_elf_count_got_entry (arg->info, arg->g, entry);
4145 return 1;
4146 }
4147
4148 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries, with DATA pointing to a
4149 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg structure. Add all entries to DATA->g,
4150 converting entries for indirect and warning symbols into entries
4151 for the target symbol. Set DATA->g to null on error. */
4152
4153 static int
4154 mips_elf_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
4155 {
4156 struct mips_got_entry new_entry, *entry;
4157 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4158 void **slot;
4159
4160 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4161 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4162 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4163 && entry->symndx == -1
4164 && (entry->d.h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4165 || entry->d.h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning))
4166 {
4167 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4168
4169 new_entry = *entry;
4170 entry = &new_entry;
4171 h = entry->d.h;
4172 do
4173 {
4174 BFD_ASSERT (h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
4175 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
4176 }
4177 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4178 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning);
4179 entry->d.h = h;
4180 }
4181 slot = htab_find_slot (arg->g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
4182 if (slot == NULL)
4183 {
4184 arg->g = NULL;
4185 return 0;
4186 }
4187 if (*slot == NULL)
4188 {
4189 if (entry == &new_entry)
4190 {
4191 entry = bfd_alloc (entry->abfd, sizeof (*entry));
4192 if (!entry)
4193 {
4194 arg->g = NULL;
4195 return 0;
4196 }
4197 *entry = new_entry;
4198 }
4199 *slot = entry;
4200 mips_elf_count_got_entry (arg->info, arg->g, entry);
4201 }
4202 return 1;
4203 }
4204
4205 /* Return the maximum number of GOT page entries required for RANGE. */
4206
4207 static bfd_vma
4208 mips_elf_pages_for_range (const struct mips_got_page_range *range)
4209 {
4210 return (range->max_addend - range->min_addend + 0x1ffff) >> 16;
4211 }
4212
4213 /* Record that G requires a page entry that can reach SEC + ADDEND. */
4214
4215 static bfd_boolean
4216 mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg,
4217 asection *sec, bfd_signed_vma addend)
4218 {
4219 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
4220 struct mips_got_page_entry lookup, *entry;
4221 struct mips_got_page_range **range_ptr, *range;
4222 bfd_vma old_pages, new_pages;
4223 void **loc;
4224
4225 /* Find the mips_got_page_entry hash table entry for this section. */
4226 lookup.sec = sec;
4227 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, &lookup, INSERT);
4228 if (loc == NULL)
4229 return FALSE;
4230
4231 /* Create a mips_got_page_entry if this is the first time we've
4232 seen the section. */
4233 entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *loc;
4234 if (!entry)
4235 {
4236 entry = bfd_zalloc (arg->info->output_bfd, sizeof (*entry));
4237 if (!entry)
4238 return FALSE;
4239
4240 entry->sec = sec;
4241 *loc = entry;
4242 }
4243
4244 /* Skip over ranges whose maximum extent cannot share a page entry
4245 with ADDEND. */
4246 range_ptr = &entry->ranges;
4247 while (*range_ptr && addend > (*range_ptr)->max_addend + 0xffff)
4248 range_ptr = &(*range_ptr)->next;
4249
4250 /* If we scanned to the end of the list, or found a range whose
4251 minimum extent cannot share a page entry with ADDEND, create
4252 a new singleton range. */
4253 range = *range_ptr;
4254 if (!range || addend < range->min_addend - 0xffff)
4255 {
4256 range = bfd_zalloc (arg->info->output_bfd, sizeof (*range));
4257 if (!range)
4258 return FALSE;
4259
4260 range->next = *range_ptr;
4261 range->min_addend = addend;
4262 range->max_addend = addend;
4263
4264 *range_ptr = range;
4265 entry->num_pages++;
4266 g->page_gotno++;
4267 return TRUE;
4268 }
4269
4270 /* Remember how many pages the old range contributed. */
4271 old_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
4272
4273 /* Update the ranges. */
4274 if (addend < range->min_addend)
4275 range->min_addend = addend;
4276 else if (addend > range->max_addend)
4277 {
4278 if (range->next && addend >= range->next->min_addend - 0xffff)
4279 {
4280 old_pages += mips_elf_pages_for_range (range->next);
4281 range->max_addend = range->next->max_addend;
4282 range->next = range->next->next;
4283 }
4284 else
4285 range->max_addend = addend;
4286 }
4287
4288 /* Record any change in the total estimate. */
4289 new_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
4290 if (old_pages != new_pages)
4291 {
4292 entry->num_pages += new_pages - old_pages;
4293 g->page_gotno += new_pages - old_pages;
4294 }
4295
4296 return TRUE;
4297 }
4298
4299 /* A htab_traverse callback for which *REFP points to a mips_got_page_ref
4300 and for which DATA points to a mips_elf_traverse_got_arg. Work out
4301 whether the page reference described by *REFP needs a GOT page entry,
4302 and record that entry in DATA->g if so. Set DATA->g to null on failure. */
4303
4304 static bfd_boolean
4305 mips_elf_resolve_got_page_ref (void **refp, void *data)
4306 {
4307 struct mips_got_page_ref *ref;
4308 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4309 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4310 asection *sec;
4311 bfd_vma addend;
4312
4313 ref = (struct mips_got_page_ref *) *refp;
4314 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4315 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (arg->info);
4316
4317 if (ref->symndx < 0)
4318 {
4319 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4320
4321 /* Global GOT_PAGEs decay to GOT_DISP and so don't need page entries. */
4322 h = ref->u.h;
4323 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (arg->info, &h->root))
4324 return 1;
4325
4326 /* Ignore undefined symbols; we'll issue an error later if
4327 appropriate. */
4328 if (!((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4329 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4330 && h->root.root.u.def.section))
4331 return 1;
4332
4333 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4334 addend = h->root.root.u.def.value + ref->addend;
4335 }
4336 else
4337 {
4338 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4339
4340 /* Read in the symbol. */
4341 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, ref->u.abfd,
4342 ref->symndx);
4343 if (isym == NULL)
4344 {
4345 arg->g = NULL;
4346 return 0;
4347 }
4348
4349 /* Get the associated input section. */
4350 sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ref->u.abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4351 if (sec == NULL)
4352 {
4353 arg->g = NULL;
4354 return 0;
4355 }
4356
4357 /* If this is a mergable section, work out the section and offset
4358 of the merged data. For section symbols, the addend specifies
4359 of the offset _of_ the first byte in the data, otherwise it
4360 specifies the offset _from_ the first byte. */
4361 if (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
4362 {
4363 void *secinfo;
4364
4365 secinfo = elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info;
4366 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
4367 addend = _bfd_merged_section_offset (ref->u.abfd, &sec, secinfo,
4368 isym->st_value + ref->addend);
4369 else
4370 addend = _bfd_merged_section_offset (ref->u.abfd, &sec, secinfo,
4371 isym->st_value) + ref->addend;
4372 }
4373 else
4374 addend = isym->st_value + ref->addend;
4375 }
4376 if (!mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (arg, sec, addend))
4377 {
4378 arg->g = NULL;
4379 return 0;
4380 }
4381 return 1;
4382 }
4383
4384 /* If any entries in G->got_entries are for indirect or warning symbols,
4385 replace them with entries for the target symbol. Convert g->got_page_refs
4386 into got_page_entry structures and estimate the number of page entries
4387 that they require. */
4388
4389 static bfd_boolean
4390 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4391 struct mips_got_info *g)
4392 {
4393 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
4394 struct mips_got_info oldg;
4395
4396 oldg = *g;
4397
4398 tga.info = info;
4399 tga.g = g;
4400 tga.value = FALSE;
4401 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_check_recreate_got, &tga);
4402 if (tga.value)
4403 {
4404 *g = oldg;
4405 g->got_entries = htab_create (htab_size (oldg.got_entries),
4406 mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
4407 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
4408 if (!g->got_entries)
4409 return FALSE;
4410
4411 htab_traverse (oldg.got_entries, mips_elf_recreate_got, &tga);
4412 if (!tga.g)
4413 return FALSE;
4414
4415 htab_delete (oldg.got_entries);
4416 }
4417
4418 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4419 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
4420 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
4421 return FALSE;
4422
4423 tga.info = info;
4424 tga.g = g;
4425 htab_traverse (g->got_page_refs, mips_elf_resolve_got_page_ref, &tga);
4426
4427 return TRUE;
4428 }
4429
4430 /* Return true if a GOT entry for H should live in the local rather than
4431 global GOT area. */
4432
4433 static bfd_boolean
4434 mips_use_local_got_p (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4435 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4436 {
4437 /* Symbols that aren't in the dynamic symbol table must live in the
4438 local GOT. This includes symbols that are completely undefined
4439 and which therefore don't bind locally. We'll report undefined
4440 symbols later if appropriate. */
4441 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
4442 return TRUE;
4443
4444 /* Symbols that bind locally can (and in the case of forced-local
4445 symbols, must) live in the local GOT. */
4446 if (h->got_only_for_calls
4447 ? SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root)
4448 : SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
4449 return TRUE;
4450
4451 /* If this is an executable that must provide a definition of the symbol,
4452 either though PLTs or copy relocations, then that address should go in
4453 the local rather than global GOT. */
4454 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && h->has_static_relocs)
4455 return TRUE;
4456
4457 return FALSE;
4458 }
4459
4460 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to the
4461 link_info structure. Decide whether the hash entry needs an entry in
4462 the global part of the primary GOT, setting global_got_area accordingly.
4463 Count the number of global symbols that are in the primary GOT only
4464 because they have relocations against them (reloc_only_gotno). */
4465
4466 static int
4467 mips_elf_count_got_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
4468 {
4469 struct bfd_link_info *info;
4470 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4471 struct mips_got_info *g;
4472
4473 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
4474 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4475 g = htab->got_info;
4476 if (h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4477 {
4478 /* Make a final decision about whether the symbol belongs in the
4479 local or global GOT. */
4480 if (mips_use_local_got_p (info, h))
4481 /* The symbol belongs in the local GOT. We no longer need this
4482 entry if it was only used for relocations; those relocations
4483 will be against the null or section symbol instead of H. */
4484 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
4485 else if (htab->is_vxworks
4486 && h->got_only_for_calls
4487 && h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
4488 /* On VxWorks, calls can refer directly to the .got.plt entry;
4489 they don't need entries in the regular GOT. .got.plt entries
4490 will be allocated by _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
4491 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
4492 else if (h->global_got_area == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
4493 {
4494 g->reloc_only_gotno++;
4495 g->global_gotno++;
4496 }
4497 }
4498 return 1;
4499 }
4500 \f
4501 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries. Add each one to the GOT
4502 given in mips_elf_traverse_got_arg DATA. Clear DATA->G on error. */
4503
4504 static int
4505 mips_elf_add_got_entry (void **entryp, void *data)
4506 {
4507 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4508 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4509 void **slot;
4510
4511 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4512 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4513 slot = htab_find_slot (arg->g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
4514 if (!slot)
4515 {
4516 arg->g = NULL;
4517 return 0;
4518 }
4519 if (!*slot)
4520 {
4521 *slot = entry;
4522 mips_elf_count_got_entry (arg->info, arg->g, entry);
4523 }
4524 return 1;
4525 }
4526
4527 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT page entries. Add each one to the GOT
4528 given in mips_elf_traverse_got_arg DATA. Clear DATA->G on error. */
4529
4530 static int
4531 mips_elf_add_got_page_entry (void **entryp, void *data)
4532 {
4533 struct mips_got_page_entry *entry;
4534 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4535 void **slot;
4536
4537 entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *entryp;
4538 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4539 slot = htab_find_slot (arg->g->got_page_entries, entry, INSERT);
4540 if (!slot)
4541 {
4542 arg->g = NULL;
4543 return 0;
4544 }
4545 if (!*slot)
4546 {
4547 *slot = entry;
4548 arg->g->page_gotno += entry->num_pages;
4549 }
4550 return 1;
4551 }
4552
4553 /* Consider merging FROM, which is ABFD's GOT, into TO. Return -1 if
4554 this would lead to overflow, 1 if they were merged successfully,
4555 and 0 if a merge failed due to lack of memory. (These values are chosen
4556 so that nonnegative return values can be returned by a htab_traverse
4557 callback.) */
4558
4559 static int
4560 mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *from,
4561 struct mips_got_info *to,
4562 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg)
4563 {
4564 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
4565 unsigned int estimate;
4566
4567 /* Work out how many page entries we would need for the combined GOT. */
4568 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4569 if (estimate >= from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno)
4570 estimate = from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno;
4571
4572 /* And conservatively estimate how many local and TLS entries
4573 would be needed. */
4574 estimate += from->local_gotno + to->local_gotno;
4575 estimate += from->tls_gotno + to->tls_gotno;
4576
4577 /* If we're merging with the primary got, any TLS relocations will
4578 come after the full set of global entries. Otherwise estimate those
4579 conservatively as well. */
4580 if (to == arg->primary && from->tls_gotno + to->tls_gotno)
4581 estimate += arg->global_count;
4582 else
4583 estimate += from->global_gotno + to->global_gotno;
4584
4585 /* Bail out if the combined GOT might be too big. */
4586 if (estimate > arg->max_count)
4587 return -1;
4588
4589 /* Transfer the bfd's got information from FROM to TO. */
4590 tga.info = arg->info;
4591 tga.g = to;
4592 htab_traverse (from->got_entries, mips_elf_add_got_entry, &tga);
4593 if (!tga.g)
4594 return 0;
4595
4596 htab_traverse (from->got_page_entries, mips_elf_add_got_page_entry, &tga);
4597 if (!tga.g)
4598 return 0;
4599
4600 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (abfd, to);
4601 return 1;
4602 }
4603
4604 /* Attempt to merge GOT G, which belongs to ABFD. Try to use as much
4605 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
4606 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
4607 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
4608 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
4609 and then make make the new got current. */
4610
4611 static bfd_boolean
4612 mips_elf_merge_got (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g,
4613 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg)
4614 {
4615 unsigned int estimate;
4616 int result;
4617
4618 if (!mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (arg->info, g))
4619 return FALSE;
4620
4621 /* Work out the number of page, local and TLS entries. */
4622 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4623 if (estimate > g->page_gotno)
4624 estimate = g->page_gotno;
4625 estimate += g->local_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
4626
4627 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
4628 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
4629 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
4630 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
4631 estimate += (g->tls_gotno > 0 ? arg->global_count : g->global_gotno);
4632
4633 if (estimate <= arg->max_count)
4634 {
4635 /* If we don't have a primary GOT, use it as
4636 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
4637 if (!arg->primary)
4638 {
4639 arg->primary = g;
4640 return TRUE;
4641 }
4642
4643 /* Try merging with the primary GOT. */
4644 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (abfd, g, arg->primary, arg);
4645 if (result >= 0)
4646 return result;
4647 }
4648
4649 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
4650 if (arg->current)
4651 {
4652 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (abfd, g, arg->current, arg);
4653 if (result >= 0)
4654 return result;
4655 }
4656
4657 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
4658 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
4659 overflows anyway. */
4660 g->next = arg->current;
4661 arg->current = g;
4662
4663 return TRUE;
4664 }
4665
4666 /* ENTRYP is a hash table entry for a mips_got_entry. Set its gotidx
4667 to GOTIDX, duplicating the entry if it has already been assigned
4668 an index in a different GOT. */
4669
4670 static bfd_boolean
4671 mips_elf_set_gotidx (void **entryp, long gotidx)
4672 {
4673 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4674
4675 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4676 if (entry->gotidx > 0)
4677 {
4678 struct mips_got_entry *new_entry;
4679
4680 new_entry = bfd_alloc (entry->abfd, sizeof (*entry));
4681 if (!new_entry)
4682 return FALSE;
4683
4684 *new_entry = *entry;
4685 *entryp = new_entry;
4686 entry = new_entry;
4687 }
4688 entry->gotidx = gotidx;
4689 return TRUE;
4690 }
4691
4692 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. DATA points to a
4693 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg in which DATA->value is the size of one
4694 GOT entry. Set DATA->g to null on failure. */
4695
4696 static int
4697 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *data)
4698 {
4699 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4700 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4701
4702 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
4703 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4704 if (entry->tls_type == GOT_TLS_NONE)
4705 return 1;
4706
4707 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4708 if (!mips_elf_set_gotidx (entryp, arg->value * arg->g->tls_assigned_gotno))
4709 {
4710 arg->g = NULL;
4711 return 0;
4712 }
4713
4714 /* Account for the entries we've just allocated. */
4715 arg->g->tls_assigned_gotno += mips_tls_got_entries (entry->tls_type);
4716 return 1;
4717 }
4718
4719 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries, where DATA points to a
4720 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg. Set the global_got_area of each global
4721 symbol to DATA->value. */
4722
4723 static int
4724 mips_elf_set_global_got_area (void **entryp, void *data)
4725 {
4726 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4727 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4728
4729 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4730 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4731 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4732 && entry->symndx == -1
4733 && entry->d.h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4734 entry->d.h->global_got_area = arg->value;
4735 return 1;
4736 }
4737
4738 /* A htab_traverse callback for secondary GOT entries, where DATA points
4739 to a mips_elf_traverse_got_arg. Assign GOT indices to global entries
4740 and record the number of relocations they require. DATA->value is
4741 the size of one GOT entry. Set DATA->g to null on failure. */
4742
4743 static int
4744 mips_elf_set_global_gotidx (void **entryp, void *data)
4745 {
4746 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4747 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4748
4749 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4750 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4751 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4752 && entry->symndx == -1
4753 && entry->d.h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4754 {
4755 if (!mips_elf_set_gotidx (entryp, arg->value * arg->g->assigned_low_gotno))
4756 {
4757 arg->g = NULL;
4758 return 0;
4759 }
4760 arg->g->assigned_low_gotno += 1;
4761
4762 if (bfd_link_pic (arg->info)
4763 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
4764 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
4765 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
4766 arg->g->relocs += 1;
4767 }
4768
4769 return 1;
4770 }
4771
4772 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries for which DATA is the
4773 bfd_link_info. Forbid any global symbols from having traditional
4774 lazy-binding stubs. */
4775
4776 static int
4777 mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs (void **entryp, void *data)
4778 {
4779 struct bfd_link_info *info;
4780 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4781 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4782
4783 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4784 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
4785 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4786 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4787
4788 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4789 && entry->symndx == -1
4790 && entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub)
4791 {
4792 entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
4793 htab->lazy_stub_count--;
4794 }
4795
4796 return 1;
4797 }
4798
4799 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
4800 the primary GOT. */
4801 static bfd_vma
4802 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
4803 {
4804 if (!g->next)
4805 return 0;
4806
4807 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
4808 if (! g)
4809 return 0;
4810
4811 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
4812
4813 g = g->next;
4814
4815 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
4816 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4817 }
4818
4819 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
4820 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
4821
4822 static bfd_boolean
4823 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4824 asection *got, bfd_size_type pages)
4825 {
4826 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4827 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
4828 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
4829 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
4830 unsigned int assign, needed_relocs;
4831 bfd *dynobj, *ibfd;
4832
4833 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4834 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4835 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4836
4837 g = htab->got_info;
4838
4839 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
4840 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
4841 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
4842 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
4843 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
4844 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
4845 - htab->reserved_gotno);
4846 got_per_bfd_arg.max_pages = pages;
4847 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
4848 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_area below for more
4849 information. */
4850 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
4851
4852 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
4853 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
4854 to be the primary GOT. */
4855 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4856 {
4857 gg = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
4858 if (gg && !mips_elf_merge_got (ibfd, gg, &got_per_bfd_arg))
4859 return FALSE;
4860 }
4861
4862 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
4863 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
4864 g->next = mips_elf_create_got_info (abfd);
4865 else
4866 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
4867 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
4868
4869 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
4870 gg = g;
4871 g = g->next;
4872
4873 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
4874 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
4875 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
4876 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
4877 list. */
4878 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (abfd, g);
4879
4880 /* Every symbol that is referenced in a dynamic relocation must be
4881 present in the primary GOT, so arrange for them to appear after
4882 those that are actually referenced. */
4883 gg->reloc_only_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
4884 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
4885
4886 tga.info = info;
4887 tga.value = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
4888 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_area, &tga);
4889 tga.value = GGA_NORMAL;
4890 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_area, &tga);
4891
4892 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
4893 [assigned_low_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
4894 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
4895 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
4896 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
4897 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
4898 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
4899 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
4900 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
4901 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
4902 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
4903 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
4904 points back to the master GOT. */
4905 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
4906 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
4907 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
4908 assign = 0;
4909 gg->next = gg;
4910
4911 do
4912 {
4913 struct mips_got_info *gn;
4914
4915 assign += htab->reserved_gotno;
4916 g->assigned_low_gotno = assign;
4917 g->local_gotno += assign;
4918 g->local_gotno += (pages < g->page_gotno ? pages : g->page_gotno);
4919 g->assigned_high_gotno = g->local_gotno - 1;
4920 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
4921
4922 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
4923 list that gg points to. g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
4924 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
4925 gn = g->next;
4926 g->next = gg->next;
4927 gg->next = g;
4928
4929 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
4930 all non-TLS entries. */
4931 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
4932 tga.g = g;
4933 tga.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4934 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, &tga);
4935 if (!tga.g)
4936 return FALSE;
4937 BFD_ASSERT (g->tls_assigned_gotno == assign);
4938
4939 /* Move onto the next GOT. It will be a secondary GOT if nonull. */
4940 g = gn;
4941
4942 /* Forbid global symbols in every non-primary GOT from having
4943 lazy-binding stubs. */
4944 if (g)
4945 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs, info);
4946 }
4947 while (g);
4948
4949 got->size = assign * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4950
4951 needed_relocs = 0;
4952 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
4953 {
4954 unsigned int save_assign;
4955
4956 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries and count how many
4957 relocations they need. */
4958 save_assign = g->assigned_low_gotno;
4959 g->assigned_low_gotno = g->local_gotno;
4960 tga.info = info;
4961 tga.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4962 tga.g = g;
4963 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_gotidx, &tga);
4964 if (!tga.g)
4965 return FALSE;
4966 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_low_gotno == g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno);
4967 g->assigned_low_gotno = save_assign;
4968
4969 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4970 {
4971 g->relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_low_gotno;
4972 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_low_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
4973 + g->next->global_gotno
4974 + g->next->tls_gotno
4975 + htab->reserved_gotno);
4976 }
4977 needed_relocs += g->relocs;
4978 }
4979 needed_relocs += g->relocs;
4980
4981 if (needed_relocs)
4982 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
4983 needed_relocs);
4984
4985 return TRUE;
4986 }
4987
4988 \f
4989 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
4990 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
4991
4992 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
4993 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
4994 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4995 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
4996 {
4997 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
4998
4999 while (relocation < relend)
5000 {
5001 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
5002 && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
5003 return relocation;
5004
5005 ++relocation;
5006 }
5007
5008 /* We didn't find it. */
5009 return NULL;
5010 }
5011
5012 /* Return whether an input relocation is against a local symbol. */
5013
5014 static bfd_boolean
5015 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
5016 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5017 asection **local_sections)
5018 {
5019 unsigned long r_symndx;
5020 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5021 size_t extsymoff;
5022
5023 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5024 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
5025 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5026
5027 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
5028 return TRUE;
5029 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
5030 return TRUE;
5031
5032 return FALSE;
5033 }
5034 \f
5035 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
5036
5037 bfd_vma
5038 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
5039 {
5040 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
5041 /* VALUE is negative. */
5042 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
5043
5044 return value;
5045 }
5046
5047 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
5048 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
5049 BITS. */
5050
5051 static bfd_boolean
5052 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
5053 {
5054 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
5055
5056 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
5057 /* The value is too big. */
5058 return TRUE;
5059 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
5060 /* The value is too small. */
5061 return TRUE;
5062
5063 /* All is well. */
5064 return FALSE;
5065 }
5066
5067 /* Calculate the %high function. */
5068
5069 static bfd_vma
5070 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
5071 {
5072 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
5073 }
5074
5075 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
5076
5077 static bfd_vma
5078 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5079 {
5080 #ifdef BFD64
5081 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
5082 #else
5083 abort ();
5084 return MINUS_ONE;
5085 #endif
5086 }
5087
5088 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
5089
5090 static bfd_vma
5091 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5092 {
5093 #ifdef BFD64
5094 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
5095 #else
5096 abort ();
5097 return MINUS_ONE;
5098 #endif
5099 }
5100 \f
5101 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
5102
5103 static bfd_boolean
5104 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
5105 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5106 {
5107 flagword flags;
5108 register asection *s;
5109
5110 if (bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
5111 {
5112 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
5113 | SEC_READONLY);
5114
5115 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
5116 if (s == NULL
5117 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5118 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5119 return FALSE;
5120
5121 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
5122 }
5123
5124 return TRUE;
5125 }
5126
5127 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
5128
5129 static bfd_boolean
5130 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5131 {
5132 flagword flags;
5133 register asection *s;
5134 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5135 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5136 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5137
5138 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5139 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
5140
5141 /* This function may be called more than once. */
5142 if (htab->root.sgot)
5143 return TRUE;
5144
5145 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5146 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
5147
5148 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
5149 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
5150 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
5151 if (s == NULL
5152 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
5153 return FALSE;
5154 htab->root.sgot = s;
5155
5156 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
5157 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
5158 are not creating a global offset table. */
5159 bh = NULL;
5160 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5161 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
5162 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5163 return FALSE;
5164
5165 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5166 h->non_elf = 0;
5167 h->def_regular = 1;
5168 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5169 h->other = (h->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN;
5170 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
5171
5172 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5173 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5174 return FALSE;
5175
5176 htab->got_info = mips_elf_create_got_info (abfd);
5177 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
5178 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5179
5180 /* We also need a .got.plt section when generating PLTs. */
5181 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
5182 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
5183 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
5184 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5185 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
5186 if (s == NULL)
5187 return FALSE;
5188 htab->root.sgotplt = s;
5189
5190 return TRUE;
5191 }
5192 \f
5193 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
5194 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols. These symbols are only special for
5195 shared objects; they are not used in executables. */
5196
5197 static bfd_boolean
5198 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5199 {
5200 return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
5201 && bfd_link_pic (info)
5202 && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
5203 || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
5204 }
5205
5206 /* Return TRUE if a relocation of type R_TYPE from INPUT_BFD might
5207 require an la25 stub. See also mips_elf_local_pic_function_p,
5208 which determines whether the destination function ever requires a
5209 stub. */
5210
5211 static bfd_boolean
5212 mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (bfd *input_bfd, int r_type,
5213 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5214 {
5215 /* We specifically ignore branches and jumps from EF_PIC objects,
5216 where the onus is on the compiler or programmer to perform any
5217 necessary initialization of $25. Sometimes such initialization
5218 is unnecessary; for example, -mno-shared functions do not use
5219 the incoming value of $25, and may therefore be called directly. */
5220 if (PIC_OBJECT_P (input_bfd))
5221 return FALSE;
5222
5223 switch (r_type)
5224 {
5225 case R_MIPS_26:
5226 case R_MIPS_PC16:
5227 case R_MIPS_PC21_S2:
5228 case R_MIPS_PC26_S2:
5229 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
5230 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
5231 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
5232 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
5233 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
5234 return TRUE;
5235
5236 case R_MIPS16_26:
5237 return !target_is_16_bit_code_p;
5238
5239 default:
5240 return FALSE;
5241 }
5242 }
5243 \f
5244 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
5245 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
5246 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
5247
5248 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
5249 On exit, set *CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P to true if the relocation field
5250 is a MIPS16 or microMIPS jump to standard MIPS code, or vice versa.
5251
5252 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
5253 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
5254 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
5255 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
5256
5257 static bfd_reloc_status_type
5258 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
5259 asection *input_section,
5260 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5261 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5262 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
5263 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
5264 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
5265 const char **namep,
5266 bfd_boolean *cross_mode_jump_p,
5267 bfd_boolean save_addend)
5268 {
5269 /* The eventual value we will return. */
5270 bfd_vma value;
5271 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
5272 occurring. */
5273 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
5274 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
5275 shared object file being produced. */
5276 bfd_vma gp;
5277 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
5278 relocated. */
5279 bfd_vma p;
5280 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
5281 bfd_vma gp0;
5282 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
5283 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
5284 during execution. */
5285 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
5286 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
5287 located. */
5288 asection *sec = NULL;
5289 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
5290 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
5291 symbol. */
5292 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
5293 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a section
5294 symbol. */
5295 bfd_boolean section_p = FALSE;
5296 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
5297 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
5298 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
5299 "__gnu_local_gp". */
5300 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
5301 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5302 size_t extsymoff;
5303 unsigned long r_symndx;
5304 int r_type;
5305 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
5306 relocation value. */
5307 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
5308 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
5309 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
5310 bfd_boolean target_is_micromips_code_p = FALSE;
5311 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5312 bfd *dynobj;
5313
5314 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5315 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5316 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
5317
5318 /* Parse the relocation. */
5319 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5320 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5321 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
5322 + input_section->output_offset
5323 + relocation->r_offset);
5324
5325 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
5326 overflowed_p = FALSE;
5327
5328 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
5329 used in the array of hash table entries. */
5330 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
5331 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
5332 local_sections);
5333 was_local_p = local_p;
5334 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
5335 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5336 else
5337 {
5338 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
5339 must come before globals. */
5340 extsymoff = 0;
5341 }
5342
5343 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
5344 if (local_p)
5345 {
5346 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (abfd);
5347 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5348
5349 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
5350 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
5351
5352 section_p = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION;
5353
5354 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5355 if (!section_p || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
5356 symbol += sym->st_value;
5357 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) && section_p)
5358 {
5359 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
5360 addend -= symbol;
5361 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5362 }
5363
5364 /* MIPS16/microMIPS text labels should be treated as odd. */
5365 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
5366 ++symbol;
5367
5368 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
5369 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
5370 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
5371 sym->st_name);
5372 if (*namep == NULL || **namep == '\0')
5373 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
5374
5375 /* For relocations against a section symbol and ones against no
5376 symbol (absolute relocations) infer the ISA mode from the addend. */
5377 if (section_p || r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
5378 {
5379 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (addend & 1) && !micromips_p;
5380 target_is_micromips_code_p = (addend & 1) && micromips_p;
5381 }
5382 /* For relocations against an absolute symbol infer the ISA mode
5383 from the value of the symbol plus addend. */
5384 else if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
5385 {
5386 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ((symbol + addend) & 1) && !micromips_p;
5387 target_is_micromips_code_p = ((symbol + addend) & 1) && micromips_p;
5388 }
5389 /* Otherwise just use the regular symbol annotation available. */
5390 else
5391 {
5392 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other);
5393 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym->st_other);
5394 }
5395 }
5396 else
5397 {
5398 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
5399
5400 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
5401 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5402 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5403 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
5404 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
5405 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
5406 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
5407
5408 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
5409 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
5410
5411 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
5412 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
5413 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
5414 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
5415 {
5416 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
5417 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
5418 if (!hi16_reloc_p (r_type) && !lo16_reloc_p (r_type))
5419 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5420
5421 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
5422 }
5423 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
5424 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
5425 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
5426 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
5427
5428
5429 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
5430 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
5431 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
5432 its defined. */
5433 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5434 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5435 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
5436 {
5437 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
5438 if (sec->output_section)
5439 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
5440 + sec->output_section->vma
5441 + sec->output_offset);
5442 else
5443 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
5444 }
5445 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5446 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
5447 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
5448 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
5449 addresses. */
5450 symbol = 0;
5451 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
5452 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5453 symbol = 0;
5454 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
5455 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
5456 {
5457 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
5458 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
5459 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
5460 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
5461 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
5462 somehow as well. */
5463 BFD_ASSERT (! bfd_link_pic (info));
5464 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
5465 symbol = 0;
5466 }
5467 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
5468 {
5469 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
5470 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
5471 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
5472 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
5473 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
5474 which is available from here:
5475 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
5476 symbol = 0;
5477 }
5478 else
5479 {
5480 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
5481 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
5482 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
5483 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
5484 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other));
5485 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
5486 }
5487
5488 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other);
5489 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other);
5490 }
5491
5492 /* If this is a reference to a 16-bit function with a stub, we need
5493 to redirect the relocation to the stub unless:
5494
5495 (a) the relocation is for a MIPS16 JAL;
5496
5497 (b) the relocation is for a MIPS16 PIC call, and there are no
5498 non-MIPS16 uses of the GOT slot; or
5499
5500 (c) the section allows direct references to MIPS16 functions. */
5501 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26
5502 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5503 && ((h != NULL
5504 && h->fn_stub != NULL
5505 && (r_type != R_MIPS16_CALL16 || h->need_fn_stub))
5506 || (local_p
5507 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
5508 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5509 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (input_section))
5510 {
5511 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
5512 have already noticed that we were going to need the
5513 stub. */
5514 if (local_p)
5515 {
5516 sec = mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
5517 value = 0;
5518 }
5519 else
5520 {
5521 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
5522 if (h->la25_stub)
5523 {
5524 /* If a LA25 header for the stub itself exists, point to the
5525 prepended LUI/ADDIU sequence. */
5526 sec = h->la25_stub->stub_section;
5527 value = h->la25_stub->offset;
5528 }
5529 else
5530 {
5531 sec = h->fn_stub;
5532 value = 0;
5533 }
5534 }
5535
5536 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + value;
5537 /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't. */
5538 target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
5539 }
5540 /* If this is a MIPS16 call with a stub, that is made through the PLT or
5541 to a standard MIPS function, we need to redirect the call to the stub.
5542 Note that we specifically exclude R_MIPS16_CALL16 from this behavior;
5543 indirect calls should use an indirect stub instead. */
5544 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5545 && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
5546 || (local_p
5547 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
5548 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5549 && ((h != NULL && h->use_plt_entry) || !target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5550 {
5551 if (local_p)
5552 sec = mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
5553 else
5554 {
5555 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
5556 out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
5557 file. */
5558 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
5559 {
5560 asection *o;
5561
5562 sec = NULL;
5563 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
5564 {
5565 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
5566 {
5567 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5568 break;
5569 }
5570 }
5571 if (sec == NULL)
5572 sec = h->call_stub;
5573 }
5574 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
5575 sec = h->call_stub;
5576 else
5577 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5578 }
5579
5580 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
5581 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5582 }
5583 /* If this is a direct call to a PIC function, redirect to the
5584 non-PIC stub. */
5585 else if (h != NULL && h->la25_stub
5586 && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (input_bfd, r_type,
5587 target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5588 {
5589 symbol = (h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_section->vma
5590 + h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_offset
5591 + h->la25_stub->offset);
5592 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other))
5593 symbol |= 1;
5594 }
5595 /* For direct MIPS16 and microMIPS calls make sure the compressed PLT
5596 entry is used if a standard PLT entry has also been made. In this
5597 case the symbol will have been set by mips_elf_set_plt_sym_value
5598 to point to the standard PLT entry, so redirect to the compressed
5599 one. */
5600 else if ((mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5601 || micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type))
5602 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5603 && h != NULL
5604 && h->use_plt_entry
5605 && h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE
5606 && h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
5607 {
5608 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (abfd);
5609
5610 sec = htab->root.splt;
5611 symbol = (sec->output_section->vma
5612 + sec->output_offset
5613 + htab->plt_header_size
5614 + htab->plt_mips_offset
5615 + h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset
5616 + 1);
5617
5618 target_is_16_bit_code_p = !micromips_p;
5619 target_is_micromips_code_p = micromips_p;
5620 }
5621
5622 /* Make sure MIPS16 and microMIPS are not used together. */
5623 if ((mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type) && target_is_micromips_code_p)
5624 || (micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type) && target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5625 {
5626 _bfd_error_handler
5627 (_("MIPS16 and microMIPS functions cannot call each other"));
5628 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5629 }
5630
5631 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
5632 mode change. However, we can ignore calls to undefined weak symbols,
5633 which should never be executed at runtime. This exception is important
5634 because the assembly writer may have "known" that any definition of the
5635 symbol would be 16-bit code, and that direct jumps were therefore
5636 acceptable. */
5637 *cross_mode_jump_p = (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5638 && !(h && h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5639 && ((mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5640 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5641 || (micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5642 && !target_is_micromips_code_p)
5643 || ((branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5644 || r_type == R_MIPS_JALR)
5645 && (target_is_16_bit_code_p
5646 || target_is_micromips_code_p))));
5647
5648 local_p = (h == NULL || mips_use_local_got_p (info, h));
5649
5650 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
5651 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
5652 if (htab->got_info)
5653 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
5654
5655 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
5656 symbol = gp;
5657
5658 /* Global R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE relocations are equivalent
5659 to R_MIPS_GOT_DISP/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP. The addend is applied by the
5660 corresponding R_MIPS_GOT_OFST/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST. */
5661 if (got_page_reloc_p (r_type) && !local_p)
5662 {
5663 r_type = (micromips_reloc_p (r_type)
5664 ? R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP : R_MIPS_GOT_DISP);
5665 addend = 0;
5666 }
5667
5668 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, and we're going
5669 to need it, get it now. */
5670 switch (r_type)
5671 {
5672 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
5673 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
5674 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5675 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5676 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5677 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5678 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5679 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5680 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5681 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
5682 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
5683 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
5684 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
5685 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
5686 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
5687 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
5688 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
5689 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5690 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
5691 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
5692 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5693 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
5694 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
5695 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5696 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
5697 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
5698 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
5699 {
5700 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5701 0, 0, NULL, r_type);
5702 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5703 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5704 }
5705 else if (!local_p)
5706 {
5707 /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
5708 entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub. */
5709 if (htab->is_vxworks
5710 && (call_hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
5711 || call_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
5712 || call16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5713 {
5714 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5715 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
5716 g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
5717 }
5718 else
5719 {
5720 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5721 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (abfd, info, input_bfd,
5722 &h->root, r_type);
5723 if (!TLS_RELOC_P (r_type)
5724 && !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5725 /* This is a static link. We must initialize the GOT entry. */
5726 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, htab->root.sgot->contents + g);
5727 }
5728 }
5729 else if (!htab->is_vxworks
5730 && (call16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5731 /* The calculation below does not involve "g". */
5732 break;
5733 else
5734 {
5735 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5736 symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
5737 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5738 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5739 }
5740
5741 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
5742 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, g);
5743 break;
5744 }
5745
5746 /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
5747 symbols are resolved by the loader. Add them to .rela.dyn. */
5748 if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
5749 {
5750 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
5751 bfd_byte *loc;
5752 asection *s;
5753
5754 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
5755 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5756
5757 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
5758 + input_section->output_offset
5759 + relocation->r_offset);
5760 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
5761 outrel.r_addend = addend;
5762 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
5763
5764 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
5765 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
5766 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
5767 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
5768 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5769
5770 *valuep = 0;
5771 return bfd_reloc_ok;
5772 }
5773
5774 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
5775 switch (r_type)
5776 {
5777 case R_MIPS_NONE:
5778 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5779
5780 case R_MIPS_16:
5781 if (howto->partial_inplace)
5782 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
5783 value = symbol + addend;
5784 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5785 break;
5786
5787 case R_MIPS_32:
5788 case R_MIPS_REL32:
5789 case R_MIPS_64:
5790 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
5791 || (htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
5792 && h != NULL
5793 && h->root.def_dynamic
5794 && !h->root.def_regular
5795 && !h->has_static_relocs))
5796 && r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
5797 && (h == NULL
5798 || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5799 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5800 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5801 {
5802 /* If we're creating a shared library, then we can't know
5803 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
5804 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
5805 linker. We must do the same for executable references to
5806 shared library symbols, unless we've decided to use copy
5807 relocs or PLTs instead. */
5808 value = addend;
5809 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
5810 info,
5811 relocation,
5812 h,
5813 sec,
5814 symbol,
5815 &value,
5816 input_section))
5817 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
5818 }
5819 else
5820 {
5821 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
5822 value = symbol + addend;
5823 else
5824 value = addend;
5825 }
5826 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5827 break;
5828
5829 case R_MIPS_PC32:
5830 value = symbol + addend - p;
5831 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5832 break;
5833
5834 case R_MIPS16_26:
5835 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
5836 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
5837 the output file that's different. That's handled in
5838 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
5839 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
5840 case R_MIPS_26:
5841 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
5842 {
5843 unsigned int shift;
5844
5845 /* Shift is 2, unusually, for microMIPS JALX. */
5846 shift = (!*cross_mode_jump_p && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1) ? 1 : 2;
5847
5848 if (howto->partial_inplace && !section_p)
5849 value = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 26 + shift);
5850 else
5851 value = addend;
5852 value += symbol;
5853
5854 /* Make sure the target of a jump is suitably aligned. Bit 0 must
5855 be the correct ISA mode selector except for weak undefined
5856 symbols. */
5857 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5858 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
5859 ? (value & 3) != (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
5860 : (value & ((1 << shift) - 1)) != (r_type != R_MIPS_26)))
5861 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5862
5863 value >>= shift;
5864 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5865 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> (26 + shift));
5866 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5867 }
5868 break;
5869
5870 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
5871 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
5872 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
5873 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
5874 & howto->dst_mask);
5875 break;
5876
5877 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
5878 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
5879 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
5880 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
5881 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
5882 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
5883 break;
5884
5885 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
5886 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
5887 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
5888 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
5889 & howto->dst_mask);
5890 break;
5891
5892 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
5893 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32:
5894 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64:
5895 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
5896 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
5897 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
5898 break;
5899
5900 case R_MIPS_HI16:
5901 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
5902 case R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
5903 if (!gp_disp_p)
5904 {
5905 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
5906 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5907 }
5908 else
5909 {
5910 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
5911 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
5912 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
5913 8: sll $v0,16
5914 12: addu $v0,$v1
5915 14: move $gp,$v0
5916 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
5917 base $pc is that used by the ADDIUPC instruction at $t9 + 4.
5918 ADDIUPC clears the low two bits of the instruction address,
5919 so the base is ($t9 + 4) & ~3. */
5920 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
5921 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - ((p + 4) & ~(bfd_vma) 0x3));
5922 /* The microMIPS .cpload sequence uses the same assembly
5923 instructions as the traditional psABI version, but the
5924 incoming $t9 has the low bit set. */
5925 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16)
5926 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 1);
5927 else
5928 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
5929 }
5930 break;
5931
5932 case R_MIPS_LO16:
5933 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
5934 case R_MICROMIPS_LO16:
5935 case R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16:
5936 if (!gp_disp_p)
5937 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
5938 else
5939 {
5940 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
5941 for this conditional. */
5942 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
5943 value = addend + gp - (p & ~(bfd_vma) 0x3);
5944 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
5945 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16)
5946 value = addend + gp - p + 3;
5947 else
5948 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
5949 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
5950 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
5951 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
5952 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
5953 this:
5954
5955 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
5956 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
5957 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
5958
5959 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
5960 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
5961 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
5962 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
5963 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
5964 not check for overflow here. */
5965 }
5966 break;
5967
5968 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
5969 case R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
5970 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
5971 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
5972 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
5973 here. */
5974
5975 /* Fall through. */
5976
5977 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
5978 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
5979 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
5980 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
5981 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
5982 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
5983 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
5984 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
5985 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
5986 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
5987 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
5988 if (howto->partial_inplace)
5989 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
5990 value = symbol + addend - gp;
5991 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
5992 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
5993 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
5994 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
5995 to them before. */
5996 if (was_local_p)
5997 value += gp0;
5998 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5999 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6000 break;
6001
6002 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
6003 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
6004 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6005 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6006 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
6007 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
6008 /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
6009 R_MIPS*_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G". */
6010 if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
6011 {
6012 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
6013 symbol + addend, !was_local_p);
6014 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
6015 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6016 value
6017 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
6018 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6019 break;
6020 }
6021
6022 /* Fall through. */
6023
6024 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6025 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6026 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6027 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6028 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
6029 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6030 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
6031 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
6032 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6033 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
6034 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
6035 value = g;
6036 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6037 break;
6038
6039 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6040 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
6041 if (!save_addend)
6042 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6043 break;
6044
6045 case R_MIPS_PC16:
6046 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
6047 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6048 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18);
6049
6050 /* No need to exclude weak undefined symbols here as they resolve
6051 to 0 and never set `*cross_mode_jump_p', so this alignment check
6052 will never trigger for them. */
6053 if (*cross_mode_jump_p
6054 ? ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 1
6055 : ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 0)
6056 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6057
6058 value = symbol + addend - p;
6059 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6060 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
6061 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6062 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6063 break;
6064
6065 case R_MIPS16_PC16_S1:
6066 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6067 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 17);
6068
6069 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6070 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6071 ? ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 0
6072 : ((symbol + addend) & 1) == 0))
6073 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6074
6075 value = symbol + addend - p;
6076 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6077 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 17);
6078 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6079 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6080 break;
6081
6082 case R_MIPS_PC21_S2:
6083 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6084 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 23);
6085
6086 if ((symbol + addend) & 3)
6087 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6088
6089 value = symbol + addend - p;
6090 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6091 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 23);
6092 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6093 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6094 break;
6095
6096 case R_MIPS_PC26_S2:
6097 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6098 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28);
6099
6100 if ((symbol + addend) & 3)
6101 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6102
6103 value = symbol + addend - p;
6104 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6105 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 28);
6106 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6107 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6108 break;
6109
6110 case R_MIPS_PC18_S3:
6111 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6112 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 21);
6113
6114 if ((symbol + addend) & 7)
6115 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6116
6117 value = symbol + addend - ((p | 7) ^ 7);
6118 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6119 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 21);
6120 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6121 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6122 break;
6123
6124 case R_MIPS_PC19_S2:
6125 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6126 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 21);
6127
6128 if ((symbol + addend) & 3)
6129 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6130
6131 value = symbol + addend - p;
6132 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6133 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 21);
6134 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6135 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6136 break;
6137
6138 case R_MIPS_PCHI16:
6139 value = mips_elf_high (symbol + addend - p);
6140 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6141 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6142 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6143 break;
6144
6145 case R_MIPS_PCLO16:
6146 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6147 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
6148 value = symbol + addend - p;
6149 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6150 break;
6151
6152 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
6153 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6154 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 8);
6155
6156 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6157 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6158 ? ((symbol + addend + 2) & 3) != 0
6159 : ((symbol + addend + 2) & 1) == 0))
6160 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6161
6162 value = symbol + addend - p;
6163 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6164 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 8);
6165 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6166 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6167 break;
6168
6169 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
6170 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6171 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 11);
6172
6173 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6174 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6175 ? ((symbol + addend + 2) & 3) != 0
6176 : ((symbol + addend + 2) & 1) == 0))
6177 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6178
6179 value = symbol + addend - p;
6180 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6181 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 11);
6182 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6183 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6184 break;
6185
6186 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
6187 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6188 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 17);
6189
6190 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6191 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6192 ? ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 0
6193 : ((symbol + addend) & 1) == 0))
6194 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6195
6196 value = symbol + addend - p;
6197 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6198 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 17);
6199 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6200 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6201 break;
6202
6203 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
6204 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6205 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 25);
6206 value = symbol + addend - ((p | 3) ^ 3);
6207 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6208 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 25);
6209 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6210 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6211 break;
6212
6213 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6214 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6215 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
6216 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
6217 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
6218 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
6219 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
6220 value = g;
6221 value = mips_elf_high (value);
6222 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6223 break;
6224
6225 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6226 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6227 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
6228 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
6229 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
6230 break;
6231
6232 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6233 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6234 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
6235 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
6236 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6237 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
6238 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6239 break;
6240
6241 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6242 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
6243 if (local_p)
6244 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
6245 else
6246 value = addend;
6247 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6248 break;
6249
6250 case R_MIPS_SUB:
6251 case R_MICROMIPS_SUB:
6252 value = symbol - addend;
6253 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6254 break;
6255
6256 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
6257 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHER:
6258 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
6259 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6260 break;
6261
6262 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
6263 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHEST:
6264 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
6265 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6266 break;
6267
6268 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
6269 case R_MICROMIPS_SCN_DISP:
6270 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
6271 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6272 break;
6273
6274 case R_MIPS_JALR:
6275 case R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
6276 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
6277 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
6278 when the symbol does not resolve locally. */
6279 if (h != NULL && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
6280 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6281 /* We can't optimize cross-mode jumps either. */
6282 if (*cross_mode_jump_p)
6283 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6284 value = symbol + addend;
6285 /* Neither we can non-instruction-aligned targets. */
6286 if (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR ? (value & 3) != 0 : (value & 1) == 0)
6287 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6288 break;
6289
6290 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
6291 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6292 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6293 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
6294 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6295
6296 default:
6297 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
6298 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
6299 }
6300
6301 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
6302 *valuep = value;
6303 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
6304 }
6305
6306 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
6307
6308 static bfd_vma
6309 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
6310 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
6311 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
6312 {
6313 bfd_vma x = 0;
6314 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
6315 unsigned int size = bfd_get_reloc_size (howto);
6316
6317 /* Obtain the bytes. */
6318 if (size != 0)
6319 x = bfd_get (8 * size, input_bfd, location);
6320
6321 return x;
6322 }
6323
6324 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
6325 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
6326 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
6327 relocation applies.
6328 CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P is true if the relocation field
6329 is a MIPS16 or microMIPS jump to standard MIPS code, or vice versa.
6330
6331 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
6332
6333 static bfd_boolean
6334 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6335 reloc_howto_type *howto,
6336 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
6337 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
6338 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
6339 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p)
6340 {
6341 bfd_vma x;
6342 bfd_byte *location;
6343 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
6344 unsigned int size;
6345
6346 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
6347 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
6348
6349 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
6350
6351 /* Obtain the current value. */
6352 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
6353
6354 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
6355 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
6356
6357 /* Set the field. */
6358 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
6359
6360 /* Detect incorrect JALX usage. If required, turn JAL or BAL into JALX. */
6361 if (!cross_mode_jump_p && jal_reloc_p (r_type))
6362 {
6363 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
6364
6365 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 ? opcode == 0x7
6366 : r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 ? opcode == 0x3c
6367 : opcode == 0x1d)
6368 {
6369 info->callbacks->einfo
6370 (_("%X%H: Unsupported JALX to the same ISA mode\n"),
6371 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6372 return TRUE;
6373 }
6374 }
6375 if (cross_mode_jump_p && jal_reloc_p (r_type))
6376 {
6377 bfd_boolean ok;
6378 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
6379 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
6380
6381 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
6382 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
6383 {
6384 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
6385 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
6386 }
6387 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
6388 {
6389 ok = ((opcode == 0x3d) || (opcode == 0x3c));
6390 jalx_opcode = 0x3c;
6391 }
6392 else
6393 {
6394 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
6395 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
6396 }
6397
6398 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. We cannot
6399 convert J or JALS to JALX. */
6400 if (!ok)
6401 {
6402 info->callbacks->einfo
6403 (_("%X%H: Unsupported jump between ISA modes; "
6404 "consider recompiling with interlinking enabled\n"),
6405 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6406 return TRUE;
6407 }
6408
6409 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
6410 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
6411 }
6412 else if (cross_mode_jump_p && b_reloc_p (r_type))
6413 {
6414 bfd_boolean ok = FALSE;
6415 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 16;
6416 bfd_vma jalx_opcode = 0;
6417 bfd_vma addr;
6418 bfd_vma dest;
6419
6420 if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1)
6421 {
6422 ok = opcode == 0x4060;
6423 jalx_opcode = 0x3c;
6424 value <<= 1;
6425 }
6426 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_PC16 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2)
6427 {
6428 ok = opcode == 0x411;
6429 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
6430 value <<= 2;
6431 }
6432
6433 if (ok && !bfd_link_pic (info))
6434 {
6435 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
6436 + input_section->output_offset
6437 + relocation->r_offset
6438 + 4);
6439 dest = addr + (((value & 0x3ffff) ^ 0x20000) - 0x20000);
6440
6441 if ((addr >> 28) << 28 != (dest >> 28) << 28)
6442 {
6443 info->callbacks->einfo
6444 (_("%X%H: Cannot convert branch between ISA modes "
6445 "to JALX: relocation out of range\n"),
6446 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6447 return TRUE;
6448 }
6449
6450 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
6451 x = ((dest >> 2) & 0x3ffffff) | jalx_opcode << 26;
6452 }
6453 else if (!mips_elf_hash_table (info)->ignore_branch_isa)
6454 {
6455 info->callbacks->einfo
6456 (_("%X%H: Unsupported branch between ISA modes\n"),
6457 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6458 return TRUE;
6459 }
6460 }
6461
6462 /* Try converting JAL to BAL and J(AL)R to B(AL), if the target is in
6463 range. */
6464 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
6465 && !cross_mode_jump_p
6466 && ((JAL_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
6467 && r_type == R_MIPS_26
6468 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
6469 || (JALR_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
6470 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
6471 && x == 0x0320f809) /* jalr t9 */
6472 || (JR_TO_B_P (input_bfd)
6473 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
6474 && (x & ~1) == 0x03200008))) /* jr t9 / jalr zero, t9 */
6475 {
6476 bfd_vma addr;
6477 bfd_vma dest;
6478 bfd_signed_vma off;
6479
6480 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
6481 + input_section->output_offset
6482 + relocation->r_offset
6483 + 4);
6484 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
6485 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
6486 else
6487 dest = value;
6488 off = dest - addr;
6489 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
6490 {
6491 if ((x & ~1) == 0x03200008) /* jr t9 / jalr zero, t9 */
6492 x = 0x10000000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* b addr */
6493 else
6494 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
6495 }
6496 }
6497
6498 /* Put the value into the output. */
6499 size = bfd_get_reloc_size (howto);
6500 if (size != 0)
6501 bfd_put (8 * size, input_bfd, x, location);
6502
6503 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, r_type, !bfd_link_relocatable (info),
6504 location);
6505
6506 return TRUE;
6507 }
6508 \f
6509 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
6510 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
6511 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
6512 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
6513
6514 static bfd_boolean
6515 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
6516 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6517 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6518 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6519 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
6520 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
6521 {
6522 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
6523 asection *sreloc;
6524 bfd *dynobj;
6525 int r_type;
6526 long indx;
6527 bfd_boolean defined_p;
6528 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6529
6530 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6531 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
6532
6533 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
6534 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6535 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
6536 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
6537 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
6538 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
6539 < sreloc->size);
6540
6541 outrel[0].r_offset =
6542 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
6543 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
6544 {
6545 outrel[1].r_offset =
6546 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
6547 outrel[2].r_offset =
6548 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
6549 }
6550
6551 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
6552 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
6553 return TRUE;
6554
6555 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
6556 {
6557 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
6558 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
6559 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
6560 *addendp += symbol;
6561 return TRUE;
6562 }
6563
6564 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
6565 in the relocation. */
6566 if (h != NULL && ! SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
6567 {
6568 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks || h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE);
6569 indx = h->root.dynindx;
6570 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6571 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
6572 else
6573 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
6574 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
6575 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
6576 undefined symbols. */
6577 defined_p = FALSE;
6578 }
6579 else
6580 {
6581 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
6582 indx = 0;
6583 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
6584 {
6585 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6586 return FALSE;
6587 }
6588 else
6589 {
6590 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
6591 if (indx == 0)
6592 {
6593 asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
6594 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
6595 }
6596 if (indx == 0)
6597 abort ();
6598 }
6599
6600 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
6601 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
6602 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
6603 local symbols because we used to generate them
6604 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
6605 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
6606 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
6607 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
6608 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
6609 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
6610 as well. */
6611 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
6612 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
6613 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
6614 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
6615 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6616 indx = 0;
6617 defined_p = TRUE;
6618 }
6619
6620 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
6621 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
6622 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
6623 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
6624 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
6625 *addendp += symbol;
6626
6627 if (htab->is_vxworks)
6628 /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this. */
6629 outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
6630 else
6631 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
6632 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
6633 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
6634 R_MIPS_REL32);
6635
6636 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
6637 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
6638 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
6639 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
6640 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
6641 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
6642 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
6643 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
6644 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
6645 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
6646 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
6647 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
6648 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
6649 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
6650 ? R_MIPS_64
6651 : R_MIPS_NONE);
6652 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
6653
6654 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
6655 correct location in the output file. */
6656 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6657 + input_section->output_offset);
6658 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6659 + input_section->output_offset);
6660 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6661 + input_section->output_offset);
6662
6663 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
6664 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
6665 relocation format is non-standard. */
6666 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
6667 {
6668 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
6669 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6670 (sreloc->contents
6671 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
6672 }
6673 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
6674 {
6675 /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations. */
6676 outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
6677 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
6678 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6679 (sreloc->contents
6680 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
6681 }
6682 else
6683 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
6684 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6685 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
6686
6687 /* We've now added another relocation. */
6688 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
6689
6690 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
6691 will be writing to it. */
6692 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
6693 |= SHF_WRITE;
6694
6695 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
6696 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
6697 {
6698 asection *scpt = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
6699 bfd_byte *cr;
6700
6701 if (scpt)
6702 {
6703 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
6704
6705 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
6706 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
6707 + input_section->output_section->vma
6708 + input_section->output_offset);
6709 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
6710 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
6711 else
6712 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
6713 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
6714 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
6715
6716 cr = (scpt->contents
6717 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
6718 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
6719 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
6720 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
6721 + scpt->reloc_count));
6722 ++scpt->reloc_count;
6723 }
6724 }
6725
6726 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
6727 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
6728 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
6729 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
6730 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6731
6732 return TRUE;
6733 }
6734 \f
6735 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
6736
6737 unsigned long
6738 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
6739 {
6740 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
6741 {
6742 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
6743 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
6744
6745 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
6746 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
6747
6748 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
6749 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
6750
6751 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
6752 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
6753
6754 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
6755 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
6756
6757 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
6758 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
6759
6760 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
6761 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
6762
6763 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
6764 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
6765
6766 case E_MIPS_MACH_5900:
6767 return bfd_mach_mips5900;
6768
6769 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
6770 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
6771
6772 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
6773 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
6774
6775 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E:
6776 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e;
6777
6778 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F:
6779 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f;
6780
6781 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A:
6782 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a;
6783
6784 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON3:
6785 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon3;
6786
6787 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2:
6788 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon2;
6789
6790 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
6791 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
6792
6793 case E_MIPS_MACH_XLR:
6794 return bfd_mach_mips_xlr;
6795
6796 default:
6797 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
6798 {
6799 default:
6800 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
6801 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
6802
6803 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
6804 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
6805
6806 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
6807 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
6808
6809 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
6810 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
6811
6812 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
6813 return bfd_mach_mips5;
6814
6815 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
6816 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
6817
6818 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
6819 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
6820
6821 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
6822 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
6823
6824 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
6825 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
6826
6827 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6:
6828 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r6;
6829
6830 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6:
6831 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r6;
6832 }
6833 }
6834
6835 return 0;
6836 }
6837
6838 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
6839
6840 static INLINE char *
6841 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
6842 {
6843 flagword flags;
6844
6845 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
6846 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
6847 {
6848 case 0:
6849 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
6850 return "N32";
6851 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
6852 return "64";
6853 else
6854 return "none";
6855 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
6856 return "O32";
6857 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
6858 return "O64";
6859 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
6860 return "EABI32";
6861 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
6862 return "EABI64";
6863 default:
6864 return "unknown abi";
6865 }
6866 }
6867 \f
6868 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
6869 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
6870 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
6871 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
6872 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
6873 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
6874 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6875 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
6876
6877 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
6878 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
6879 definition in a shared library. */
6880 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
6881 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6882 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
6883
6884 /* This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
6885
6886 void
6887 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
6888 {
6889 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
6890
6891 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use. */
6892 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
6893 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
6894 {
6895 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
6896 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
6897 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
6898 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
6899 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
6900 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
6901 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
6902 {
6903 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
6904 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
6905 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
6906 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6907 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6908 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
6909 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
6910 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
6911 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6912 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6913 }
6914 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6915 break;
6916
6917 case SHN_COMMON:
6918 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
6919 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
6920 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
6921 || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
6922 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
6923 break;
6924 /* Fall through. */
6925 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
6926 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
6927 {
6928 /* Initialize the small common section. */
6929 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
6930 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
6931 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6932 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6933 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
6934 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
6935 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
6936 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6937 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6938 }
6939 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6940 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
6941 break;
6942
6943 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
6944 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6945 break;
6946
6947 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
6948 {
6949 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
6950
6951 if (section != NULL)
6952 {
6953 asym->section = section;
6954 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
6955 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
6956 base address to make it an offset. */
6957 asym->value -= section->vma;
6958 }
6959 }
6960 break;
6961
6962 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
6963 {
6964 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
6965
6966 if (section != NULL)
6967 {
6968 asym->section = section;
6969 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
6970 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
6971 base address to make it an offset. */
6972 asym->value -= section->vma;
6973 }
6974 }
6975 break;
6976 }
6977
6978 /* If this is an odd-valued function symbol, assume it's a MIPS16
6979 or microMIPS one. */
6980 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_FUNC
6981 && (asym->value & 1) != 0)
6982 {
6983 asym->value--;
6984 if (MICROMIPS_P (abfd))
6985 elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other
6986 = ELF_ST_SET_MICROMIPS (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
6987 else
6988 elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other
6989 = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS16 (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
6990 }
6991 }
6992 \f
6993 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
6994 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
6995
6996 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
6997 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
6998 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
6999 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
7000 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
7001
7002 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
7003 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
7004 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
7005 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
7006
7007 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
7008 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
7009 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
7010 We therefore take the following approach:
7011
7012 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
7013 determine the pointer size.
7014
7015 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
7016 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
7017
7018 - Otherwise punt.
7019
7020 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
7021 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
7022 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
7023 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
7024 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
7025
7026 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
7027 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
7028 did so. */
7029
7030 unsigned int
7031 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
7032 {
7033 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
7034 return 8;
7035 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
7036 {
7037 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
7038
7039 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
7040 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
7041 if (long32_p && long64_p)
7042 return 0;
7043 if (long32_p)
7044 return 4;
7045 if (long64_p)
7046 return 8;
7047
7048 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
7049 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
7050 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
7051 == R_MIPS_64))
7052 return 8;
7053
7054 return 0;
7055 }
7056 return 4;
7057 }
7058 \f
7059 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
7060 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
7061 same address. For example, if we have code like:
7062
7063 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
7064 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
7065 jalr $25
7066
7067 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
7068 will jump there rather than to .text.
7069
7070 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
7071 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
7072
7073 bfd_boolean
7074 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
7075 {
7076 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
7077 }
7078 \f
7079 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
7080 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
7081 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
7082 a better way. */
7083
7084 bfd_boolean
7085 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
7086 {
7087 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
7088 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
7089 {
7090 bfd_byte buf[4];
7091
7092 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
7093 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
7094
7095 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
7096 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
7097 SEEK_SET) != 0)
7098 return FALSE;
7099 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
7100 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
7101 return FALSE;
7102 }
7103
7104 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
7105 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
7106 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
7107 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
7108 {
7109 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
7110
7111 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
7112 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
7113 so that we don't have to read them again.
7114 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
7115 through the section contents to see if there is an
7116 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
7117
7118 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
7119 l = contents;
7120 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
7121 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
7122 {
7123 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
7124
7125 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
7126 &intopt);
7127 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
7128 {
7129 _bfd_error_handler
7130 /* xgettext:c-format */
7131 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
7132 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
7133 break;
7134 }
7135 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7136 {
7137 bfd_byte buf[8];
7138
7139 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
7140 (hdr->sh_offset
7141 + (l - contents)
7142 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
7143 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
7144 SEEK_SET) != 0)
7145 return FALSE;
7146 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
7147 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
7148 return FALSE;
7149 }
7150 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7151 {
7152 bfd_byte buf[4];
7153
7154 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
7155 (hdr->sh_offset
7156 + (l - contents)
7157 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
7158 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
7159 SEEK_SET) != 0)
7160 return FALSE;
7161 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
7162 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
7163 return FALSE;
7164 }
7165 l += intopt.size;
7166 }
7167 }
7168
7169 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
7170 {
7171 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
7172
7173 /* .sbss is not handled specially here because the GNU/Linux
7174 prelinker can convert .sbss from NOBITS to PROGBITS and
7175 changing it back to NOBITS breaks the binary. The entry in
7176 _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections will ensure the correct flags
7177 are set on .sbss if BFD creates it without reading it from an
7178 input file, and without special handling here the flags set
7179 on it in an input file will be followed. */
7180 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
7181 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
7182 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
7183 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
7184 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
7185 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
7186 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
7187 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
7188 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
7189 {
7190 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
7191 {
7192 unsigned int adjust;
7193
7194 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
7195 if (adjust != 0)
7196 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
7197 }
7198 }
7199 }
7200
7201 return TRUE;
7202 }
7203
7204 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
7205 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
7206 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
7207
7208 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
7209 how to. */
7210
7211 bfd_boolean
7212 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
7213 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
7214 const char *name,
7215 int shindex)
7216 {
7217 flagword flags = 0;
7218
7219 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
7220 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
7221 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
7222 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
7223 probably get away with this. */
7224 switch (hdr->sh_type)
7225 {
7226 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
7227 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
7228 return FALSE;
7229 break;
7230 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
7231 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
7232 return FALSE;
7233 break;
7234 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
7235 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
7236 return FALSE;
7237 break;
7238 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
7239 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
7240 return FALSE;
7241 break;
7242 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
7243 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
7244 return FALSE;
7245 break;
7246 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
7247 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
7248 return FALSE;
7249 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
7250 break;
7251 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
7252 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
7253 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
7254 return FALSE;
7255 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
7256 break;
7257 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
7258 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
7259 return FALSE;
7260 break;
7261 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
7262 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
7263 return FALSE;
7264 break;
7265 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
7266 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
7267 return FALSE;
7268 break;
7269 case SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS:
7270 if (!MIPS_ELF_ABIFLAGS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
7271 return FALSE;
7272 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
7273 break;
7274 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
7275 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
7276 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
7277 return FALSE;
7278 break;
7279 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
7280 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
7281 return FALSE;
7282 break;
7283 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
7284 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
7285 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
7286 return FALSE;
7287 break;
7288 default:
7289 break;
7290 }
7291
7292 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
7293 return FALSE;
7294
7295 if (flags)
7296 {
7297 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
7298 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
7299 hdr->bfd_section)
7300 | flags)))
7301 return FALSE;
7302 }
7303
7304 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS)
7305 {
7306 Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 ext;
7307
7308 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
7309 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
7310 return FALSE;
7311 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_in (abfd, &ext,
7312 &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags);
7313 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags.version != 0)
7314 return FALSE;
7315 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
7316 }
7317
7318 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
7319
7320 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
7321 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
7322 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
7323 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
7324 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
7325 {
7326 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
7327 Elf32_RegInfo s;
7328
7329 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
7330 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
7331 return FALSE;
7332 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
7333 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
7334 }
7335
7336 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
7337 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
7338 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
7339 they should agree. */
7340 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
7341 {
7342 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
7343
7344 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7345 if (contents == NULL)
7346 return FALSE;
7347 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
7348 0, hdr->sh_size))
7349 {
7350 free (contents);
7351 return FALSE;
7352 }
7353 l = contents;
7354 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
7355 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
7356 {
7357 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
7358
7359 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
7360 &intopt);
7361 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
7362 {
7363 _bfd_error_handler
7364 /* xgettext:c-format */
7365 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
7366 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
7367 break;
7368 }
7369 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7370 {
7371 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
7372
7373 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
7374 (abfd,
7375 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
7376 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
7377 &intreg);
7378 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
7379 }
7380 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7381 {
7382 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
7383
7384 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
7385 (abfd,
7386 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
7387 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
7388 &intreg);
7389 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
7390 }
7391 l += intopt.size;
7392 }
7393 free (contents);
7394 }
7395
7396 return TRUE;
7397 }
7398
7399 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
7400 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
7401 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
7402
7403 bfd_boolean
7404 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
7405 {
7406 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
7407
7408 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
7409 {
7410 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
7411 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
7412 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
7413 }
7414 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
7415 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
7416 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
7417 {
7418 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
7419 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
7420 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
7421 }
7422 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
7423 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
7424 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
7425 {
7426 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
7427 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
7428 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
7429 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
7430 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
7431 else
7432 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
7433 }
7434 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
7435 {
7436 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
7437 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
7438 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
7439 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7440 {
7441 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
7442 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
7443 else
7444 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
7445 }
7446 else
7447 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
7448 }
7449 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7450 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
7451 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
7452 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
7453 {
7454 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7455 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
7456 #if 0
7457 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
7458 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
7459 #endif
7460 }
7461 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
7462 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
7463 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
7464 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
7465 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
7466 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
7467 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
7468 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
7469 {
7470 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
7471 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7472 }
7473 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
7474 {
7475 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
7476 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7477 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
7478 }
7479 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
7480 {
7481 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
7482 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
7483 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7484 }
7485 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.abiflags"))
7486 {
7487 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS;
7488 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0);
7489 }
7490 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
7491 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
7492 {
7493 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
7494
7495 /* Irix facilities such as libexc expect a single .debug_frame
7496 per executable, the system ones have NOSTRIP set and the linker
7497 doesn't merge sections with different flags so ... */
7498 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_frame"))
7499 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7500 }
7501 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
7502 {
7503 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
7504 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
7505 final_write_processing. */
7506 }
7507 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
7508 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
7509 {
7510 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
7511 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7512 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
7513 }
7514 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
7515 {
7516 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
7517 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
7518 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
7519 }
7520
7521 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
7522 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
7523 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
7524 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
7525 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
7526
7527 return TRUE;
7528 }
7529
7530 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
7531 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
7532 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
7533 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
7534 the .scommon section. */
7535
7536 bfd_boolean
7537 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7538 asection *sec, int *retval)
7539 {
7540 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
7541 {
7542 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
7543 return TRUE;
7544 }
7545 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
7546 {
7547 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
7548 return TRUE;
7549 }
7550 return FALSE;
7551 }
7552 \f
7553 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
7554 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
7555
7556 bfd_boolean
7557 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7558 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
7559 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7560 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
7561 {
7562 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7563 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
7564 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
7565 {
7566 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
7567 *namep = NULL;
7568 return TRUE;
7569 }
7570
7571 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
7572 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
7573 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
7574 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
7575 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
7576 is not done for them. */
7577 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
7578 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
7579 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
7580 {
7581 *namep = NULL;
7582 return TRUE;
7583 }
7584
7585 switch (sym->st_shndx)
7586 {
7587 case SHN_COMMON:
7588 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
7589 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
7590 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
7591 || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
7592 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
7593 break;
7594 /* Fall through. */
7595 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
7596 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
7597 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
7598 *valp = sym->st_size;
7599 break;
7600
7601 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
7602 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
7603 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
7604 {
7605 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
7606 asection *elf_text_section;
7607 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
7608
7609 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7610 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
7611 return FALSE;
7612
7613 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
7614 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7615 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
7616 return FALSE;
7617
7618 /* Initialize the section. */
7619
7620 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
7621 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
7622
7623 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
7624 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
7625
7626 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
7627 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
7628 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
7629 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
7630 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
7631 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
7632 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
7633 }
7634 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
7635 bfd_link_pic (info). I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
7636 so I took it out. */
7637 *secp = mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
7638 break;
7639
7640 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
7641 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
7642 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
7643 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
7644 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
7645 {
7646 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
7647 asection *elf_data_section;
7648 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
7649
7650 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7651 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
7652 return FALSE;
7653
7654 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
7655 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7656 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
7657 return FALSE;
7658
7659 /* Initialize the section. */
7660
7661 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
7662 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
7663
7664 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
7665 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
7666
7667 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
7668 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
7669 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
7670 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
7671 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
7672 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
7673 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
7674 }
7675 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
7676 bfd_link_pic (info). I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
7677 so I took it out. */
7678 *secp = mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
7679 break;
7680
7681 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
7682 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
7683 break;
7684 }
7685
7686 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7687 && ! bfd_link_pic (info)
7688 && info->output_bfd->xvec == abfd->xvec
7689 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
7690 {
7691 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7692 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
7693
7694 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
7695 bh = NULL;
7696 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7697 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
7698 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7699 return FALSE;
7700
7701 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7702 h->non_elf = 0;
7703 h->def_regular = 1;
7704 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
7705
7706 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7707 return FALSE;
7708
7709 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
7710 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol = h;
7711 }
7712
7713 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
7714 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
7715 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
7716 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
7717 ++*valp;
7718
7719 return TRUE;
7720 }
7721
7722 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
7723 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
7724 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
7725
7726 int
7727 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
7728 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7729 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
7730 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7731 {
7732 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
7733 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
7734 common in the output file. */
7735 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
7736 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
7737 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
7738
7739 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
7740 sym->st_value &= ~1;
7741
7742 return 1;
7743 }
7744 \f
7745 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
7746
7747 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
7748
7749 bfd_boolean
7750 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7751 {
7752 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7753 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
7754 flagword flags;
7755 register asection *s;
7756 const char * const *namep;
7757 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7758
7759 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7760 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
7761
7762 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
7763 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
7764
7765 /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
7766 EABI doesn't. */
7767 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7768 {
7769 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynamic");
7770 if (s != NULL)
7771 {
7772 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
7773 return FALSE;
7774 }
7775 }
7776
7777 /* We need to create .got section. */
7778 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
7779 return FALSE;
7780
7781 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
7782 return FALSE;
7783
7784 /* Create .stub section. */
7785 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd,
7786 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
7787 flags | SEC_CODE);
7788 if (s == NULL
7789 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
7790 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
7791 return FALSE;
7792 htab->sstubs = s;
7793
7794 if (!mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7795 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7796 && bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
7797 {
7798 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
7799 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
7800 if (s == NULL
7801 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
7802 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
7803 return FALSE;
7804 }
7805
7806 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
7807 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
7808 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
7809 the linker takes such action. */
7810 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
7811 {
7812 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
7813 {
7814 bh = NULL;
7815 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7816 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
7817 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7818 return FALSE;
7819
7820 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7821 h->non_elf = 0;
7822 h->def_regular = 1;
7823 h->type = STT_SECTION;
7824
7825 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7826 return FALSE;
7827 }
7828
7829 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
7830 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7831 {
7832 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
7833 return FALSE;
7834 }
7835
7836 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
7837 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".hash");
7838 if (s != NULL)
7839 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7840
7841 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynsym");
7842 if (s != NULL)
7843 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7844
7845 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynstr");
7846 if (s != NULL)
7847 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7848
7849 /* ??? */
7850 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
7851 if (s != NULL)
7852 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7853
7854 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynamic");
7855 if (s != NULL)
7856 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
7857 }
7858
7859 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
7860 {
7861 const char *name;
7862
7863 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
7864 bh = NULL;
7865 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7866 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
7867 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7868 return FALSE;
7869
7870 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7871 h->non_elf = 0;
7872 h->def_regular = 1;
7873 h->type = STT_SECTION;
7874
7875 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7876 return FALSE;
7877
7878 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
7879 {
7880 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
7881 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
7882 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
7883 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
7884 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rld_map");
7885 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7886
7887 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
7888 bh = NULL;
7889 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7890 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
7891 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7892 return FALSE;
7893
7894 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7895 h->non_elf = 0;
7896 h->def_regular = 1;
7897 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
7898
7899 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7900 return FALSE;
7901 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol = h;
7902 }
7903 }
7904
7905 /* Create the .plt, .rel(a).plt, .dynbss and .rel(a).bss sections.
7906 Also, on VxWorks, create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_ symbol. */
7907 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
7908 return FALSE;
7909
7910 /* Do the usual VxWorks handling. */
7911 if (htab->is_vxworks
7912 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
7913 return FALSE;
7914
7915 return TRUE;
7916 }
7917 \f
7918 /* Return true if relocation REL against section SEC is a REL rather than
7919 RELA relocation. RELOCS is the first relocation in the section and
7920 ABFD is the bfd that contains SEC. */
7921
7922 static bfd_boolean
7923 mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
7924 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7925 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
7926 {
7927 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7928 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7929
7930 /* To determine which flavor of relocation this is, we depend on the
7931 fact that the INPUT_SECTION's REL_HDR is read before RELA_HDR. */
7932 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
7933 if (rel_hdr == NULL)
7934 return FALSE;
7935 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7936 return ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7937 < NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
7938 }
7939
7940 /* Read the addend for REL relocation REL, which belongs to bfd ABFD.
7941 HOWTO is the relocation's howto and CONTENTS points to the contents
7942 of the section that REL is against. */
7943
7944 static bfd_vma
7945 mips_elf_read_rel_addend (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7946 reloc_howto_type *howto, bfd_byte *contents)
7947 {
7948 bfd_byte *location;
7949 unsigned int r_type;
7950 bfd_vma addend;
7951 bfd_vma bytes;
7952
7953 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7954 location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7955
7956 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
7957 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
7958 bytes = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, abfd, contents);
7959 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
7960
7961 addend = bytes & howto->src_mask;
7962
7963 /* Shift is 2, unusually, for microMIPS JALX. Adjust the addend
7964 accordingly. */
7965 if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 && (bytes >> 26) == 0x3c)
7966 addend <<= 1;
7967
7968 return addend;
7969 }
7970
7971 /* REL is a relocation in ABFD that needs a partnering LO16 relocation
7972 and *ADDEND is the addend for REL itself. Look for the LO16 relocation
7973 and update *ADDEND with the final addend. Return true on success
7974 or false if the LO16 could not be found. RELEND is the exclusive
7975 upper bound on the relocations for REL's section. */
7976
7977 static bfd_boolean
7978 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (bfd *abfd,
7979 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7980 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend,
7981 bfd_byte *contents, bfd_vma *addend)
7982 {
7983 unsigned int r_type, lo16_type;
7984 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7985 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7986 bfd_vma l;
7987
7988 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7989 if (mips16_reloc_p (r_type))
7990 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7991 else if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type))
7992 lo16_type = R_MICROMIPS_LO16;
7993 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_PCHI16)
7994 lo16_type = R_MIPS_PCLO16;
7995 else
7996 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7997
7998 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend, left-shifted by
7999 sixteen bits, and the LO16 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the
8000 code does a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of the
8001 LO16 value.)
8002
8003 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
8004
8005 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must
8006 be immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
8007 relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
8008 relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
8009 relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar
8010 extension in general, as that is useful for GCC.
8011
8012 In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes the LO16 but keeps
8013 the corresponding HI16. This is strictly speaking a violation of
8014 the ABI but not immediately harmful. */
8015 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (abfd, lo16_type, rel, relend);
8016 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
8017 return FALSE;
8018
8019 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
8020 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, lo16_type, FALSE);
8021 l = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, lo16_relocation, lo16_howto, contents);
8022
8023 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
8024 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
8025
8026 *addend <<= 16;
8027 *addend += l;
8028 return TRUE;
8029 }
8030
8031 /* Try to read the contents of section SEC in bfd ABFD. Return true and
8032 store the contents in *CONTENTS on success. Assume that *CONTENTS
8033 already holds the contents if it is nonull on entry. */
8034
8035 static bfd_boolean
8036 mips_elf_get_section_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_byte **contents)
8037 {
8038 if (*contents)
8039 return TRUE;
8040
8041 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
8042 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
8043 {
8044 *contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
8045 return TRUE;
8046 }
8047
8048 return bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, contents);
8049 }
8050
8051 /* Make a new PLT record to keep internal data. */
8052
8053 static struct plt_entry *
8054 mips_elf_make_plt_record (bfd *abfd)
8055 {
8056 struct plt_entry *entry;
8057
8058 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
8059 if (entry == NULL)
8060 return NULL;
8061
8062 entry->stub_offset = MINUS_ONE;
8063 entry->mips_offset = MINUS_ONE;
8064 entry->comp_offset = MINUS_ONE;
8065 entry->gotplt_index = MINUS_ONE;
8066 return entry;
8067 }
8068
8069 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
8070 allocate space in the global offset table and record the need for
8071 standard MIPS and compressed procedure linkage table entries. */
8072
8073 bfd_boolean
8074 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
8075 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
8076 {
8077 const char *name;
8078 bfd *dynobj;
8079 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8080 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
8081 size_t extsymoff;
8082 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
8083 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
8084 asection *sreloc;
8085 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8086 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8087 bfd_byte *contents;
8088 bfd_vma addend;
8089 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8090
8091 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8092 return TRUE;
8093
8094 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8095 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8096
8097 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8098 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8099 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
8100 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8101
8102 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8103 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
8104
8105 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
8106
8107 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
8108 if (FN_STUB_P (name))
8109 {
8110 unsigned long r_symndx;
8111
8112 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
8113 this is for. */
8114
8115 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (bed, sec, relocs, rel_end);
8116 if (r_symndx == 0)
8117 {
8118 _bfd_error_handler
8119 /* xgettext:c-format */
8120 (_("%B: Warning: cannot determine the target function for"
8121 " stub section `%s'"),
8122 abfd, name);
8123 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8124 return FALSE;
8125 }
8126
8127 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
8128 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
8129 {
8130 asection *o;
8131
8132 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
8133 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
8134 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
8135 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
8136 {
8137 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
8138 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
8139
8140 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
8141 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
8142 || o->reloc_count == 0
8143 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
8144 continue;
8145
8146 sec_relocs
8147 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
8148 info->keep_memory);
8149 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
8150 return FALSE;
8151
8152 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
8153 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
8154 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
8155 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info)))
8156 break;
8157
8158 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
8159 free (sec_relocs);
8160
8161 if (r < rend)
8162 break;
8163 }
8164
8165 if (o == NULL)
8166 {
8167 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
8168 not need it. Since this function is called before
8169 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
8170 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
8171 flag. */
8172 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8173 return TRUE;
8174 }
8175
8176 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
8177 this BFD. */
8178 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
8179 {
8180 unsigned long symcount;
8181 asection **n;
8182 bfd_size_type amt;
8183
8184 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
8185 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
8186 else
8187 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8188 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
8189 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8190 if (n == NULL)
8191 return FALSE;
8192 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
8193 }
8194
8195 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8196 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
8197
8198 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
8199 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
8200 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
8201 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
8202 }
8203 else
8204 {
8205 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8206
8207 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
8208 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
8209
8210 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8211 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8212 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
8213
8214 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
8215
8216 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
8217 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
8218 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
8219 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
8220 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
8221 if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
8222 {
8223 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8224 return TRUE;
8225 }
8226
8227 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8228 h->fn_stub = sec;
8229 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
8230 }
8231 }
8232 else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
8233 {
8234 unsigned long r_symndx;
8235 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8236 asection **loc;
8237
8238 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
8239 this is for. */
8240
8241 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (bed, sec, relocs, rel_end);
8242 if (r_symndx == 0)
8243 {
8244 _bfd_error_handler
8245 /* xgettext:c-format */
8246 (_("%B: Warning: cannot determine the target function for"
8247 " stub section `%s'"),
8248 abfd, name);
8249 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8250 return FALSE;
8251 }
8252
8253 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
8254 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
8255 {
8256 asection *o;
8257
8258 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
8259 needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
8260 that refers to this symbol. */
8261 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
8262 {
8263 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
8264 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
8265
8266 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
8267 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
8268 || o->reloc_count == 0
8269 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
8270 continue;
8271
8272 sec_relocs
8273 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
8274 info->keep_memory);
8275 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
8276 return FALSE;
8277
8278 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
8279 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
8280 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
8281 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
8282 break;
8283
8284 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
8285 free (sec_relocs);
8286
8287 if (r < rend)
8288 break;
8289 }
8290
8291 if (o == NULL)
8292 {
8293 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
8294 not need it. Since this function is called before
8295 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
8296 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
8297 flag. */
8298 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8299 return TRUE;
8300 }
8301
8302 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
8303 this BFD. */
8304 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
8305 {
8306 unsigned long symcount;
8307 asection **n;
8308 bfd_size_type amt;
8309
8310 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
8311 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
8312 else
8313 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8314 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
8315 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8316 if (n == NULL)
8317 return FALSE;
8318 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
8319 }
8320
8321 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8322 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
8323
8324 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
8325 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
8326 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
8327 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
8328 }
8329 else
8330 {
8331 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
8332 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
8333
8334 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
8335
8336 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
8337 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
8338 else
8339 loc = &h->call_stub;
8340
8341 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
8342 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
8343 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
8344 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
8345 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
8346 if (*loc != NULL)
8347 {
8348 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8349 return TRUE;
8350 }
8351
8352 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8353 *loc = sec;
8354 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
8355 }
8356 }
8357
8358 sreloc = NULL;
8359 contents = NULL;
8360 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
8361 {
8362 unsigned long r_symndx;
8363 unsigned int r_type;
8364 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8365 bfd_boolean can_make_dynamic_p;
8366 bfd_boolean call_reloc_p;
8367 bfd_boolean constrain_symbol_p;
8368
8369 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
8370 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
8371
8372 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
8373 h = NULL;
8374 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
8375 {
8376 _bfd_error_handler
8377 /* xgettext:c-format */
8378 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
8379 abfd, name);
8380 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8381 return FALSE;
8382 }
8383 else
8384 {
8385 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
8386 if (h != NULL)
8387 {
8388 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8389 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8390 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
8391
8392 /* PR15323, ref flags aren't set for references in the
8393 same object. */
8394 h->root.non_ir_ref = 1;
8395 }
8396 }
8397
8398 /* Set CAN_MAKE_DYNAMIC_P to true if we can convert this
8399 relocation into a dynamic one. */
8400 can_make_dynamic_p = FALSE;
8401
8402 /* Set CALL_RELOC_P to true if the relocation is for a call,
8403 and if pointer equality therefore doesn't matter. */
8404 call_reloc_p = FALSE;
8405
8406 /* Set CONSTRAIN_SYMBOL_P if we need to take the relocation
8407 into account when deciding how to define the symbol.
8408 Relocations in nonallocatable sections such as .pdr and
8409 .debug* should have no effect. */
8410 constrain_symbol_p = ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0);
8411
8412 switch (r_type)
8413 {
8414 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8415 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8416 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8417 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
8418 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
8419 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
8420 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
8421 call_reloc_p = TRUE;
8422 /* Fall through. */
8423
8424 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
8425 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8426 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8427 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8428 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
8429 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8430 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8431 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
8432 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
8433 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
8434 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8435 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
8436 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
8437 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
8438 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
8439 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
8440 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8441 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
8442 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
8443 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8444 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
8445 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
8446 if (dynobj == NULL)
8447 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
8448 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info))
8449 return FALSE;
8450 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8451 {
8452 _bfd_error_handler
8453 /* xgettext:c-format */
8454 (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
8455 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
8456 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8457 return FALSE;
8458 }
8459 can_make_dynamic_p = TRUE;
8460 break;
8461
8462 case R_MIPS_NONE:
8463 case R_MIPS_JALR:
8464 case R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
8465 /* These relocations have empty fields and are purely there to
8466 provide link information. The symbol value doesn't matter. */
8467 constrain_symbol_p = FALSE;
8468 break;
8469
8470 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
8471 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
8472 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
8473 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
8474 /* GP-relative relocations always resolve to a definition in a
8475 regular input file, ignoring the one-definition rule. This is
8476 important for the GP setup sequence in NewABI code, which
8477 always resolves to a local function even if other relocations
8478 against the symbol wouldn't. */
8479 constrain_symbol_p = FALSE;
8480 break;
8481
8482 case R_MIPS_32:
8483 case R_MIPS_REL32:
8484 case R_MIPS_64:
8485 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
8486 must be handled using copy relocs or PLT entries; it is not
8487 possible to convert this relocation into a dynamic one.
8488
8489 For executables that use PLTs and copy-relocs, we have a
8490 choice between converting the relocation into a dynamic
8491 one or using copy relocations or PLT entries. It is
8492 usually better to do the former, unless the relocation is
8493 against a read-only section. */
8494 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
8495 || (h != NULL
8496 && !htab->is_vxworks
8497 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__gnu_local_gp") != 0
8498 && !(!info->nocopyreloc
8499 && !PIC_OBJECT_P (abfd)
8500 && MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))))
8501 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
8502 {
8503 can_make_dynamic_p = TRUE;
8504 if (dynobj == NULL)
8505 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
8506 }
8507 break;
8508
8509 case R_MIPS_26:
8510 case R_MIPS_PC16:
8511 case R_MIPS_PC21_S2:
8512 case R_MIPS_PC26_S2:
8513 case R_MIPS16_26:
8514 case R_MIPS16_PC16_S1:
8515 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
8516 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
8517 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
8518 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
8519 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
8520 call_reloc_p = TRUE;
8521 break;
8522 }
8523
8524 if (h)
8525 {
8526 if (constrain_symbol_p)
8527 {
8528 if (!can_make_dynamic_p)
8529 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_static_relocs = 1;
8530
8531 if (!call_reloc_p)
8532 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
8533
8534 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has
8535 relocations related to taking the function's address.
8536 This doesn't apply to VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer
8537 to a .got.plt entry instead of a normal .got entry. */
8538 if (!htab->is_vxworks && (!can_make_dynamic_p || !call_reloc_p))
8539 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
8540 }
8541
8542 /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
8543 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader. Allocate
8544 room for them in .rela.dyn. */
8545 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
8546 {
8547 if (sreloc == NULL)
8548 {
8549 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
8550 if (sreloc == NULL)
8551 return FALSE;
8552 }
8553 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
8554 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
8555 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
8556 relocations against the text segment. */
8557 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8558 }
8559 }
8560 else if (call_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
8561 || got_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
8562 || got_disp_reloc_p (r_type)
8563 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type) && htab->is_vxworks))
8564 {
8565 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
8566 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
8567 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
8568 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS*_GOT16 and
8569 R_MIPS*_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
8570 always evaluate to "G". We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
8571 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
8572 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
8573 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
8574 rel->r_addend, info, r_type))
8575 return FALSE;
8576 }
8577
8578 if (h != NULL
8579 && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (abfd, r_type,
8580 ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->other)))
8581 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
8582
8583 switch (r_type)
8584 {
8585 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8586 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
8587 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
8588 if (h == NULL)
8589 {
8590 _bfd_error_handler
8591 /* xgettext:c-format */
8592 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
8593 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
8594 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8595 return FALSE;
8596 }
8597 /* Fall through. */
8598
8599 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8600 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8601 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
8602 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
8603 if (h != NULL)
8604 {
8605 /* Make sure there is room in the regular GOT to hold the
8606 function's address. We may eliminate it in favour of
8607 a .got.plt entry later; see mips_elf_count_got_symbols. */
8608 if (!mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, TRUE,
8609 r_type))
8610 return FALSE;
8611
8612 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
8613 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
8614 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
8615 h->needs_plt = 1;
8616 h->type = STT_FUNC;
8617 }
8618 break;
8619
8620 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8621 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8622 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
8623 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
8624 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8625 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8626 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
8627 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
8628 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
8629 if (!h || got_page_reloc_p (r_type))
8630 {
8631 /* This relocation needs (or may need, if h != NULL) a
8632 page entry in the GOT. For R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE we do not
8633 know for sure until we know whether the symbol is
8634 preemptible. */
8635 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (abfd, sec, relocs, rel))
8636 {
8637 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
8638 return FALSE;
8639 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
8640 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, rel,
8641 howto, contents);
8642 if (got16_reloc_p (r_type))
8643 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (abfd, rel, rel_end,
8644 contents, &addend);
8645 else
8646 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
8647 }
8648 else
8649 addend = rel->r_addend;
8650 if (!mips_elf_record_got_page_ref (info, abfd, r_symndx,
8651 h, addend))
8652 return FALSE;
8653
8654 if (h)
8655 {
8656 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
8657 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8658
8659 /* This symbol is definitely not overridable. */
8660 if (hmips->root.def_regular
8661 && ! (bfd_link_pic (info) && ! info->symbolic
8662 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
8663 h = NULL;
8664 }
8665 }
8666 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
8667 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
8668 /* Fall through. */
8669
8670 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8671 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
8672 if (h && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
8673 FALSE, r_type))
8674 return FALSE;
8675 break;
8676
8677 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8678 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8679 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8680 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8681 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
8682 /* Fall through */
8683
8684 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
8685 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
8686 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
8687 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
8688 {
8689 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
8690 h = NULL;
8691 }
8692 /* Fall through */
8693
8694 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
8695 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
8696 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
8697 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
8698 for TLS GD relocations. */
8699 if (h != NULL)
8700 {
8701 if (!mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
8702 FALSE, r_type))
8703 return FALSE;
8704 }
8705 else
8706 {
8707 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
8708 rel->r_addend,
8709 info, r_type))
8710 return FALSE;
8711 }
8712 break;
8713
8714 case R_MIPS_32:
8715 case R_MIPS_REL32:
8716 case R_MIPS_64:
8717 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
8718 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
8719 no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation. */
8720 if (can_make_dynamic_p)
8721 {
8722 if (sreloc == NULL)
8723 {
8724 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
8725 if (sreloc == NULL)
8726 return FALSE;
8727 }
8728 if (bfd_link_pic (info) && h == NULL)
8729 {
8730 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
8731 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
8732 relocs. Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn. */
8733 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
8734 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
8735 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
8736 relocations against the text segment. */
8737 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8738 }
8739 else
8740 {
8741 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8742
8743 /* For a shared object, we must copy this relocation
8744 unless the symbol turns out to be undefined and
8745 weak with non-default visibility, in which case
8746 it will be left as zero.
8747
8748 We could elide R_MIPS_REL32 for locally binding symbols
8749 in shared libraries, but do not yet do so.
8750
8751 For an executable, we only need to copy this
8752 reloc if the symbol is defined in a dynamic
8753 object. */
8754 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8755 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
8756 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
8757 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
8758 are relocations against the text segment. */
8759 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
8760 }
8761 }
8762
8763 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
8764 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
8765 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
8766 break;
8767
8768 case R_MIPS_26:
8769 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
8770 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
8771 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
8772 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
8773 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
8774 case R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
8775 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
8776 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
8777 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
8778 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
8779 break;
8780
8781 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
8782 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
8783 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
8784 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
8785 return FALSE;
8786 break;
8787
8788 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
8789 used. Record for later use during GC. */
8790 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
8791 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
8792 if (h != NULL
8793 && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
8794 return FALSE;
8795 break;
8796
8797 default:
8798 break;
8799 }
8800
8801 /* Record the need for a PLT entry. At this point we don't know
8802 yet if we are going to create a PLT in the first place, but
8803 we only record whether the relocation requires a standard MIPS
8804 or a compressed code entry anyway. If we don't make a PLT after
8805 all, then we'll just ignore these arrangements. Likewise if
8806 a PLT entry is not created because the symbol is satisfied
8807 locally. */
8808 if (h != NULL
8809 && (branch_reloc_p (r_type)
8810 || mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
8811 || micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type))
8812 && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
8813 {
8814 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
8815 h->plt.plist = mips_elf_make_plt_record (abfd);
8816 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
8817 return FALSE;
8818
8819 if (branch_reloc_p (r_type))
8820 h->plt.plist->need_mips = TRUE;
8821 else
8822 h->plt.plist->need_comp = TRUE;
8823 }
8824
8825 /* See if this reloc would need to refer to a MIPS16 hard-float stub,
8826 if there is one. We only need to handle global symbols here;
8827 we decide whether to keep or delete stubs for local symbols
8828 when processing the stub's relocations. */
8829 if (h != NULL
8830 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (r_type)
8831 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (sec))
8832 {
8833 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
8834
8835 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8836 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
8837 }
8838
8839 /* Refuse some position-dependent relocations when creating a
8840 shared library. Do not refuse R_MIPS_32 / R_MIPS_64; they're
8841 not PIC, but we can create dynamic relocations and the result
8842 will be fine. Also do not refuse R_MIPS_LO16, which can be
8843 combined with R_MIPS_GOT16. */
8844 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8845 {
8846 switch (r_type)
8847 {
8848 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
8849 case R_MIPS_HI16:
8850 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
8851 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
8852 case R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
8853 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHER:
8854 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHEST:
8855 /* Don't refuse a high part relocation if it's against
8856 no symbol (e.g. part of a compound relocation). */
8857 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
8858 break;
8859
8860 /* R_MIPS_HI16 against _gp_disp is used for $gp setup,
8861 and has a special meaning. */
8862 if (!NEWABI_P (abfd) && h != NULL
8863 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_gp_disp") == 0)
8864 break;
8865
8866 /* Likewise __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__ on VxWorks. */
8867 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
8868 break;
8869
8870 /* FALLTHROUGH */
8871
8872 case R_MIPS16_26:
8873 case R_MIPS_26:
8874 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
8875 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
8876 _bfd_error_handler
8877 /* xgettext:c-format */
8878 (_("%B: relocation %s against `%s' can not be used when making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC"),
8879 abfd, howto->name,
8880 (h) ? h->root.root.string : "a local symbol");
8881 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8882 return FALSE;
8883 default:
8884 break;
8885 }
8886 }
8887 }
8888
8889 return TRUE;
8890 }
8891 \f
8892 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
8893
8894 static bfd_boolean
8895 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8896 {
8897 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
8898 bfd *dynobj;
8899 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8900 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8901
8902 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8903 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8904
8905 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8906 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8907
8908 /* VxWorks executables are handled elsewhere; we only need to
8909 allocate relocations in shared objects. */
8910 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8911 return TRUE;
8912
8913 /* Ignore indirect symbols. All relocations against such symbols
8914 will be redirected to the target symbol. */
8915 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
8916 return TRUE;
8917
8918 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, or we are creating
8919 a shared library, we will need to copy any R_MIPS_32 or
8920 R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output file. */
8921 if (! bfd_link_relocatable (info)
8922 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
8923 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
8924 || (!h->def_regular && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
8925 || bfd_link_pic (info)))
8926 {
8927 bfd_boolean do_copy = TRUE;
8928
8929 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8930 {
8931 /* Do not copy relocations for undefined weak symbols with
8932 non-default visibility. */
8933 if (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
8934 do_copy = FALSE;
8935
8936 /* Make sure undefined weak symbols are output as a dynamic
8937 symbol in PIEs. */
8938 else if (h->dynindx == -1 && !h->forced_local)
8939 {
8940 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
8941 return FALSE;
8942 }
8943 }
8944
8945 if (do_copy)
8946 {
8947 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for this symbol,
8948 the SVR4 psABI requires it to have a dynamic symbol table
8949 index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are dynamic
8950 relocations against it.
8951
8952 VxWorks does not enforce the same mapping between the GOT
8953 and the symbol table, so the same requirement does not
8954 apply there. */
8955 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
8956 {
8957 if (hmips->global_got_area > GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
8958 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
8959 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
8960 }
8961
8962 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
8963 (dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
8964 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
8965 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
8966 against the text segment. */
8967 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8968 }
8969 }
8970
8971 return TRUE;
8972 }
8973
8974 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
8975 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
8976 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
8977 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
8978 understand. */
8979
8980 bfd_boolean
8981 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
8982 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
8983 {
8984 bfd *dynobj;
8985 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8986 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8987 asection *s, *srel;
8988
8989 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8990 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8991
8992 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8993 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8994
8995 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
8996 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
8997 && (h->needs_plt
8998 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
8999 || (h->def_dynamic
9000 && h->ref_regular
9001 && !h->def_regular)));
9002
9003 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9004
9005 /* If there are call relocations against an externally-defined symbol,
9006 see whether we can create a MIPS lazy-binding stub for it. We can
9007 only do this if all references to the function are through call
9008 relocations, and in that case, the traditional lazy-binding stubs
9009 are much more efficient than PLT entries.
9010
9011 Traditional stubs are only available on SVR4 psABI-based systems;
9012 VxWorks always uses PLTs instead. */
9013 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
9014 {
9015 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9016 return TRUE;
9017
9018 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
9019 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
9020 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
9021 executable and the shared library. */
9022 if (!h->def_regular)
9023 {
9024 hmips->needs_lazy_stub = TRUE;
9025 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
9026 return TRUE;
9027 }
9028 }
9029 /* As above, VxWorks requires PLT entries for externally-defined
9030 functions that are only accessed through call relocations.
9031
9032 Both VxWorks and non-VxWorks targets also need PLT entries if there
9033 are static-only relocations against an externally-defined function.
9034 This can technically occur for shared libraries if there are
9035 branches to the symbol, although it is unlikely that this will be
9036 used in practice due to the short ranges involved. It can occur
9037 for any relative or absolute relocation in executables; in that
9038 case, the PLT entry becomes the function's canonical address. */
9039 else if (((h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
9040 || (h->type == STT_FUNC && hmips->has_static_relocs))
9041 && htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs
9042 && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
9043 && !(ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
9044 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
9045 {
9046 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (info->output_bfd);
9047 bfd_boolean newabi_p = NEWABI_P (info->output_bfd);
9048
9049 /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, then make some
9050 basic setup. Also work out PLT entry sizes. We'll need them
9051 for PLT offset calculations. */
9052 if (htab->plt_mips_offset + htab->plt_comp_offset == 0)
9053 {
9054 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.sgotplt->size == 0);
9055 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_got_index == 0);
9056
9057 /* If we're using the PLT additions to the psABI, each PLT
9058 entry is 16 bytes and the PLT0 entry is 32 bytes.
9059 Encourage better cache usage by aligning. We do this
9060 lazily to avoid pessimizing traditional objects. */
9061 if (!htab->is_vxworks
9062 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->root.splt, 5))
9063 return FALSE;
9064
9065 /* Make sure that .got.plt is word-aligned. We do this lazily
9066 for the same reason as above. */
9067 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->root.sgotplt,
9068 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
9069 return FALSE;
9070
9071 /* On non-VxWorks targets, the first two entries in .got.plt
9072 are reserved. */
9073 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9074 htab->plt_got_index
9075 += (get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->got_header_size
9076 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9077
9078 /* On VxWorks, also allocate room for the header's
9079 .rela.plt.unloaded entries. */
9080 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
9081 htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9082
9083 /* Now work out the sizes of individual PLT entries. */
9084 if (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info))
9085 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9086 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
9087 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
9088 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9089 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
9090 else if (newabi_p)
9091 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9092 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9093 else if (!micromips_p)
9094 {
9095 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9096 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9097 htab->plt_comp_entry_size
9098 = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry);
9099 }
9100 else if (htab->insn32)
9101 {
9102 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9103 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9104 htab->plt_comp_entry_size
9105 = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry);
9106 }
9107 else
9108 {
9109 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9110 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9111 htab->plt_comp_entry_size
9112 = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry);
9113 }
9114 }
9115
9116 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
9117 h->plt.plist = mips_elf_make_plt_record (dynobj);
9118 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
9119 return FALSE;
9120
9121 /* There are no defined MIPS16 or microMIPS PLT entries for VxWorks,
9122 n32 or n64, so always use a standard entry there.
9123
9124 If the symbol has a MIPS16 call stub and gets a PLT entry, then
9125 all MIPS16 calls will go via that stub, and there is no benefit
9126 to having a MIPS16 entry. And in the case of call_stub a
9127 standard entry actually has to be used as the stub ends with a J
9128 instruction. */
9129 if (newabi_p
9130 || htab->is_vxworks
9131 || hmips->call_stub
9132 || hmips->call_fp_stub)
9133 {
9134 h->plt.plist->need_mips = TRUE;
9135 h->plt.plist->need_comp = FALSE;
9136 }
9137
9138 /* Otherwise, if there are no direct calls to the function, we
9139 have a free choice of whether to use standard or compressed
9140 entries. Prefer microMIPS entries if the object is known to
9141 contain microMIPS code, so that it becomes possible to create
9142 pure microMIPS binaries. Prefer standard entries otherwise,
9143 because MIPS16 ones are no smaller and are usually slower. */
9144 if (!h->plt.plist->need_mips && !h->plt.plist->need_comp)
9145 {
9146 if (micromips_p)
9147 h->plt.plist->need_comp = TRUE;
9148 else
9149 h->plt.plist->need_mips = TRUE;
9150 }
9151
9152 if (h->plt.plist->need_mips)
9153 {
9154 h->plt.plist->mips_offset = htab->plt_mips_offset;
9155 htab->plt_mips_offset += htab->plt_mips_entry_size;
9156 }
9157 if (h->plt.plist->need_comp)
9158 {
9159 h->plt.plist->comp_offset = htab->plt_comp_offset;
9160 htab->plt_comp_offset += htab->plt_comp_entry_size;
9161 }
9162
9163 /* Reserve the corresponding .got.plt entry now too. */
9164 h->plt.plist->gotplt_index = htab->plt_got_index++;
9165
9166 /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
9167 symbol's value to the address of the stub. */
9168 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && !h->def_regular)
9169 hmips->use_plt_entry = TRUE;
9170
9171 /* Make room for the R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation. */
9172 htab->root.srelplt->size += (htab->is_vxworks
9173 ? MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj)
9174 : MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj));
9175
9176 /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations. */
9177 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
9178 htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9179
9180 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
9181 dynamic will now refer to the PLT entry instead. */
9182 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
9183
9184 return TRUE;
9185 }
9186
9187 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
9188 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
9189 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
9190 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
9191 {
9192 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9193 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
9194 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
9195 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
9196 return TRUE;
9197 }
9198
9199 /* Otherwise, there is nothing further to do for symbols defined
9200 in regular objects. */
9201 if (h->def_regular)
9202 return TRUE;
9203
9204 /* There's also nothing more to do if we'll convert all relocations
9205 against this symbol into dynamic relocations. */
9206 if (!hmips->has_static_relocs)
9207 return TRUE;
9208
9209 /* We're now relying on copy relocations. Complain if we have
9210 some that we can't convert. */
9211 if (!htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs || bfd_link_pic (info))
9212 {
9213 _bfd_error_handler (_("non-dynamic relocations refer to "
9214 "dynamic symbol %s"),
9215 h->root.root.string);
9216 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9217 return FALSE;
9218 }
9219
9220 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
9221 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
9222 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
9223 object will contain position independent code, so all references
9224 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
9225 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
9226 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
9227 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
9228 same memory location for the variable. */
9229
9230 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
9231 {
9232 s = htab->root.sdynrelro;
9233 srel = htab->root.sreldynrelro;
9234 }
9235 else
9236 {
9237 s = htab->root.sdynbss;
9238 srel = htab->root.srelbss;
9239 }
9240 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
9241 {
9242 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9243 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9244 else
9245 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
9246 h->needs_copy = 1;
9247 }
9248
9249 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
9250 dynamic will now refer to the local copy instead. */
9251 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
9252
9253 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
9254 }
9255 \f
9256 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
9257 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
9258 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
9259
9260 bfd_boolean
9261 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9262 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9263 {
9264 asection *sect;
9265 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9266 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
9267
9268 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9269 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9270
9271 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
9272 sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
9273 if (sect != NULL)
9274 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, sect, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
9275
9276 /* The .MIPS.abiflags section has a fixed size. */
9277 sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".MIPS.abiflags");
9278 if (sect != NULL)
9279 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, sect, sizeof (Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0));
9280
9281 hti.info = info;
9282 hti.output_bfd = output_bfd;
9283 hti.error = FALSE;
9284 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
9285 mips_elf_check_symbols, &hti);
9286 if (hti.error)
9287 return FALSE;
9288
9289 return TRUE;
9290 }
9291
9292 /* If the link uses a GOT, lay it out and work out its size. */
9293
9294 static bfd_boolean
9295 mips_elf_lay_out_got (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9296 {
9297 bfd *dynobj;
9298 asection *s;
9299 struct mips_got_info *g;
9300 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
9301 bfd_size_type page_gotno;
9302 bfd *ibfd;
9303 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
9304 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9305
9306 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9307 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9308
9309 s = htab->root.sgot;
9310 if (s == NULL)
9311 return TRUE;
9312
9313 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9314 g = htab->got_info;
9315
9316 /* Allocate room for the reserved entries. VxWorks always reserves
9317 3 entries; other objects only reserve 2 entries. */
9318 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_low_gotno == 0);
9319 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9320 htab->reserved_gotno = 3;
9321 else
9322 htab->reserved_gotno = 2;
9323 g->local_gotno += htab->reserved_gotno;
9324 g->assigned_low_gotno = htab->reserved_gotno;
9325
9326 /* Decide which symbols need to go in the global part of the GOT and
9327 count the number of reloc-only GOT symbols. */
9328 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_count_got_symbols, info);
9329
9330 if (!mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (info, g))
9331 return FALSE;
9332
9333 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
9334 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
9335 required. */
9336 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9337 {
9338 asection *subsection;
9339
9340 for (subsection = ibfd->sections;
9341 subsection;
9342 subsection = subsection->next)
9343 {
9344 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
9345 continue;
9346 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
9347 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
9348 }
9349 }
9350
9351 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9352 /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS*_GOT16
9353 relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
9354 not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE. */
9355 page_gotno = 0;
9356 else
9357 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
9358 sections. Is 5 enough? */
9359 page_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
9360
9361 /* Choose the smaller of the two page estimates; both are intended to be
9362 conservative. */
9363 if (page_gotno > g->page_gotno)
9364 page_gotno = g->page_gotno;
9365
9366 g->local_gotno += page_gotno;
9367 g->assigned_high_gotno = g->local_gotno - 1;
9368
9369 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9370 s->size += g->global_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9371 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9372
9373 /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs. It initializes $gp to
9374 __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
9375 dynamic loader. */
9376 if (!htab->is_vxworks && s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
9377 {
9378 if (!mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, s, page_gotno))
9379 return FALSE;
9380 }
9381 else
9382 {
9383 /* Record that all bfds use G. This also has the effect of freeing
9384 the per-bfd GOTs, which we no longer need. */
9385 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9386 if (mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE))
9387 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (ibfd, g);
9388 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (output_bfd, g);
9389
9390 /* Set up TLS entries. */
9391 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
9392 tga.info = info;
9393 tga.g = g;
9394 tga.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9395 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, &tga);
9396 if (!tga.g)
9397 return FALSE;
9398 BFD_ASSERT (g->tls_assigned_gotno
9399 == g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno + g->tls_gotno);
9400
9401 /* Each VxWorks GOT entry needs an explicit relocation. */
9402 if (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info))
9403 g->relocs += g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
9404
9405 /* Allocate room for the TLS relocations. */
9406 if (g->relocs)
9407 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, g->relocs);
9408 }
9409
9410 return TRUE;
9411 }
9412
9413 /* Estimate the size of the .MIPS.stubs section. */
9414
9415 static void
9416 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9417 {
9418 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9419 bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
9420
9421 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9422 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9423
9424 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
9425 return;
9426
9427 /* IRIX rld assumes that a function stub isn't at the end of the .text
9428 section, so add a dummy entry to the end. */
9429 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
9430
9431 /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
9432 At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
9433 and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
9434 be needed. */
9435 dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
9436 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
9437
9438 /* Determine the size of one stub entry. There's no disadvantage
9439 from using microMIPS code here, so for the sake of pure-microMIPS
9440 binaries we prefer it whenever there's any microMIPS code in
9441 output produced at all. This has a benefit of stubs being
9442 shorter by 4 bytes each too, unless in the insn32 mode. */
9443 if (!MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd))
9444 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
9445 ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
9446 : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
9447 else if (htab->insn32)
9448 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
9449 ? MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
9450 : MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
9451 else
9452 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
9453 ? MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
9454 : MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
9455
9456 htab->sstubs->size = htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size;
9457 }
9458
9459 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to a
9460 mips_htab_traverse_info. If H needs a traditional MIPS lazy-binding
9461 stub, allocate an entry in the stubs section. */
9462
9463 static bfd_boolean
9464 mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
9465 {
9466 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti = data;
9467 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9468 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9469 bfd *output_bfd;
9470
9471 info = hti->info;
9472 output_bfd = hti->output_bfd;
9473 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9474 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9475
9476 if (h->needs_lazy_stub)
9477 {
9478 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd);
9479 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
9480 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
9481
9482 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.dynobj != NULL);
9483 if (h->root.plt.plist == NULL)
9484 h->root.plt.plist = mips_elf_make_plt_record (htab->sstubs->owner);
9485 if (h->root.plt.plist == NULL)
9486 {
9487 hti->error = TRUE;
9488 return FALSE;
9489 }
9490 h->root.root.u.def.section = htab->sstubs;
9491 h->root.root.u.def.value = htab->sstubs->size + isa_bit;
9492 h->root.plt.plist->stub_offset = htab->sstubs->size;
9493 h->root.other = other;
9494 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
9495 }
9496 return TRUE;
9497 }
9498
9499 /* Allocate offsets in the stubs section to each symbol that needs one.
9500 Set the final size of the .MIPS.stub section. */
9501
9502 static bfd_boolean
9503 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9504 {
9505 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
9506 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd);
9507 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
9508 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
9509 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9510 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
9511 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9512 bfd *dynobj;
9513
9514 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9515 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9516
9517 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
9518 return TRUE;
9519
9520 htab->sstubs->size = 0;
9521 hti.info = info;
9522 hti.output_bfd = output_bfd;
9523 hti.error = FALSE;
9524 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub, &hti);
9525 if (hti.error)
9526 return FALSE;
9527 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
9528 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size
9529 == htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size);
9530
9531 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9532 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
9533 h = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (dynobj, info, htab->sstubs, "_MIPS_STUBS_");
9534 if (h == NULL)
9535 return FALSE;
9536 h->root.u.def.value = isa_bit;
9537 h->other = other;
9538 h->type = STT_FUNC;
9539
9540 return TRUE;
9541 }
9542
9543 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to a
9544 bfd_link_info. If H uses the address of a PLT entry as the value
9545 of the symbol, then set the entry in the symbol table now. Prefer
9546 a standard MIPS PLT entry. */
9547
9548 static bfd_boolean
9549 mips_elf_set_plt_sym_value (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
9550 {
9551 struct bfd_link_info *info = data;
9552 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (info->output_bfd);
9553 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9554 unsigned int other;
9555 bfd_vma isa_bit;
9556 bfd_vma val;
9557
9558 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9559 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9560
9561 if (h->use_plt_entry)
9562 {
9563 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.plt.plist != NULL);
9564 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE
9565 || h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE);
9566
9567 val = htab->plt_header_size;
9568 if (h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
9569 {
9570 isa_bit = 0;
9571 val += h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset;
9572 other = 0;
9573 }
9574 else
9575 {
9576 isa_bit = 1;
9577 val += htab->plt_mips_offset + h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset;
9578 other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : STO_MIPS16;
9579 }
9580 val += isa_bit;
9581 /* For VxWorks, point at the PLT load stub rather than the lazy
9582 resolution stub; this stub will become the canonical function
9583 address. */
9584 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9585 val += 8;
9586
9587 h->root.root.u.def.section = htab->root.splt;
9588 h->root.root.u.def.value = val;
9589 h->root.other = other;
9590 }
9591
9592 return TRUE;
9593 }
9594
9595 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
9596
9597 bfd_boolean
9598 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9599 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9600 {
9601 bfd *dynobj;
9602 asection *s, *sreldyn;
9603 bfd_boolean reltext;
9604 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9605
9606 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9607 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9608 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9609 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
9610
9611 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9612 {
9613 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
9614 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
9615 {
9616 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
9617 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9618 s->size
9619 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
9620 s->contents
9621 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
9622 }
9623
9624 /* Figure out the size of the PLT header if we know that we
9625 are using it. For the sake of cache alignment always use
9626 a standard header whenever any standard entries are present
9627 even if microMIPS entries are present as well. This also
9628 lets the microMIPS header rely on the value of $v0 only set
9629 by microMIPS entries, for a small size reduction.
9630
9631 Set symbol table entry values for symbols that use the
9632 address of their PLT entry now that we can calculate it.
9633
9634 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_ symbol if we
9635 haven't already in _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections. */
9636 if (htab->root.splt && htab->plt_mips_offset + htab->plt_comp_offset != 0)
9637 {
9638 bfd_boolean micromips_p = (MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd)
9639 && !htab->plt_mips_offset);
9640 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
9641 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
9642 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9643 bfd_vma size;
9644
9645 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
9646 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.sgotplt->size == 0);
9647 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.splt->size == 0);
9648
9649 if (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info))
9650 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
9651 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
9652 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
9653 else if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9654 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry);
9655 else if (ABI_N32_P (output_bfd))
9656 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry);
9657 else if (!micromips_p)
9658 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
9659 else if (htab->insn32)
9660 size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
9661 else
9662 size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
9663
9664 htab->plt_header_is_comp = micromips_p;
9665 htab->plt_header_size = size;
9666 htab->root.splt->size = (size
9667 + htab->plt_mips_offset
9668 + htab->plt_comp_offset);
9669 htab->root.sgotplt->size = (htab->plt_got_index
9670 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9671
9672 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_set_plt_sym_value, info);
9673
9674 if (htab->root.hplt == NULL)
9675 {
9676 h = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (dynobj, info, htab->root.splt,
9677 "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_");
9678 htab->root.hplt = h;
9679 if (h == NULL)
9680 return FALSE;
9681 }
9682
9683 h = htab->root.hplt;
9684 h->root.u.def.value = isa_bit;
9685 h->other = other;
9686 h->type = STT_FUNC;
9687 }
9688 }
9689
9690 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
9691 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->root, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
9692
9693 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (output_bfd, info);
9694
9695 if (!mips_elf_lay_out_got (output_bfd, info))
9696 return FALSE;
9697
9698 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (info);
9699
9700 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
9701 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
9702 memory for them. */
9703 reltext = FALSE;
9704 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9705 {
9706 const char *name;
9707
9708 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
9709 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
9710 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
9711
9712 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
9713 continue;
9714
9715 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
9716 {
9717 if (s->size != 0)
9718 {
9719 const char *outname;
9720 asection *target;
9721
9722 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
9723 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
9724 If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
9725 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
9726 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
9727 not. */
9728 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
9729 s->output_section);
9730 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
9731 if ((target != NULL
9732 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
9733 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
9734 || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
9735 reltext = TRUE;
9736
9737 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
9738 to copy relocs into the output file. */
9739 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
9740 s->reloc_count = 0;
9741
9742 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
9743 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
9744 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
9745 will move them around between input sections'
9746 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
9747 broken, so don't let it run. */
9748 info->combreloc = 0;
9749 }
9750 }
9751 else if (bfd_link_executable (info)
9752 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
9753 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
9754 {
9755 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
9756 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
9757 s->size += MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE (output_bfd);
9758 }
9759 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
9760 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
9761 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
9762 else if (s == htab->root.splt)
9763 {
9764 /* If the last PLT entry has a branch delay slot, allocate
9765 room for an extra nop to fill the delay slot. This is
9766 for CPUs without load interlocking. */
9767 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd)
9768 && ! htab->is_vxworks && s->size > 0)
9769 s->size += 4;
9770 }
9771 else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
9772 && s != htab->root.sgot
9773 && s != htab->root.sgotplt
9774 && s != htab->sstubs
9775 && s != htab->root.sdynbss
9776 && s != htab->root.sdynrelro)
9777 {
9778 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
9779 continue;
9780 }
9781
9782 if (s->size == 0)
9783 {
9784 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
9785 continue;
9786 }
9787
9788 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
9789 continue;
9790
9791 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
9792 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
9793 if (s->contents == NULL)
9794 {
9795 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
9796 return FALSE;
9797 }
9798 }
9799
9800 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9801 {
9802 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
9803 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
9804 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
9805 the .dynamic section. */
9806
9807 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
9808 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. This must come first because glibc
9809 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and some tools
9810 may only look at the first one they see. */
9811 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
9812 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
9813 return FALSE;
9814
9815 if (bfd_link_executable (info)
9816 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL, 0))
9817 return FALSE;
9818
9819 /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
9820 used by the debugger. */
9821 if (bfd_link_executable (info)
9822 && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
9823 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
9824 return FALSE;
9825
9826 if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
9827 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9828
9829 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
9830 {
9831 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
9832 return FALSE;
9833
9834 /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag. It will be set again if we
9835 write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
9836 at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
9837 absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative. */
9838 info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
9839 }
9840
9841 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
9842 return FALSE;
9843
9844 sreldyn = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9845 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9846 {
9847 /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn. It does not
9848 use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags. */
9849 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0)
9850 {
9851 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
9852 return FALSE;
9853
9854 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
9855 return FALSE;
9856
9857 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
9858 return FALSE;
9859 }
9860 }
9861 else
9862 {
9863 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0)
9864 {
9865 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
9866 return FALSE;
9867
9868 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
9869 return FALSE;
9870
9871 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
9872 return FALSE;
9873 }
9874
9875 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
9876 return FALSE;
9877
9878 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
9879 return FALSE;
9880
9881 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
9882 return FALSE;
9883
9884 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
9885 return FALSE;
9886
9887 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
9888 return FALSE;
9889
9890 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
9891 return FALSE;
9892
9893 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
9894 return FALSE;
9895
9896 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
9897 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
9898 return FALSE;
9899
9900 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
9901 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
9902 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
9903 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
9904 return FALSE;
9905 }
9906 if (htab->root.splt->size > 0)
9907 {
9908 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
9909 return FALSE;
9910
9911 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
9912 return FALSE;
9913
9914 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
9915 return FALSE;
9916
9917 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_PLTGOT, 0))
9918 return FALSE;
9919 }
9920 if (htab->is_vxworks
9921 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
9922 return FALSE;
9923 }
9924
9925 return TRUE;
9926 }
9927 \f
9928 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
9929 Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
9930 LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
9931 and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes. */
9932
9933 static void
9934 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
9935 bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
9936 asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
9937 {
9938 unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
9939 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9940 asection *sec;
9941
9942 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
9943 {
9944 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
9945 if (gprel16_reloc_p (r_type)
9946 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
9947 || literal_reloc_p (r_type))
9948 {
9949 rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
9950 rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
9951 }
9952
9953 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
9954 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
9955
9956 /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging. */
9957 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
9958 {
9959 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
9960 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
9961 }
9962
9963 /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c. */
9964 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
9965 rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
9966 }
9967 }
9968
9969 /* Handle relocations against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
9970 or sections discarded by a linker script. We use this wrapper around
9971 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION to handle triplets of compound relocs
9972 on 64-bit ELF targets. In this case for any relocation handled, which
9973 always be the first in a triplet, the remaining two have to be processed
9974 together with the first, even if they are R_MIPS_NONE. It is the symbol
9975 index referred by the first reloc that applies to all the three and the
9976 remaining two never refer to an object symbol. And it is the final
9977 relocation (the last non-null one) that determines the output field of
9978 the whole relocation so retrieve the corresponding howto structure for
9979 the relocatable field to be cleared by RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION.
9980
9981 Note that RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION is a macro that uses "continue"
9982 and therefore requires to be pasted in a loop. It also defines a block
9983 and does not protect any of its arguments, hence the extra brackets. */
9984
9985 static void
9986 mips_reloc_against_discarded_section (bfd *output_bfd,
9987 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9988 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
9989 Elf_Internal_Rela **rel,
9990 const Elf_Internal_Rela **relend,
9991 bfd_boolean rel_reloc,
9992 reloc_howto_type *howto,
9993 bfd_byte *contents)
9994 {
9995 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
9996 int count = bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
9997 unsigned int r_type;
9998 int i;
9999
10000 for (i = count - 1; i > 0; i--)
10001 {
10002 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, (*rel)[i].r_info);
10003 if (r_type != R_MIPS_NONE)
10004 {
10005 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
10006 break;
10007 }
10008 }
10009 do
10010 {
10011 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION (info, input_bfd, input_section,
10012 (*rel), count, (*relend),
10013 howto, i, contents);
10014 }
10015 while (0);
10016 }
10017
10018 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
10019
10020 bfd_boolean
10021 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
10022 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
10023 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
10024 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
10025 asection **local_sections)
10026 {
10027 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
10028 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
10029 bfd_vma addend = 0;
10030 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
10031 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
10032
10033 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
10034 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
10035 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
10036 {
10037 const char *name;
10038 bfd_vma value = 0;
10039 reloc_howto_type *howto;
10040 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p = FALSE;
10041 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
10042 REL relocation. */
10043 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
10044 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
10045 const char *msg;
10046 unsigned long r_symndx;
10047 asection *sec;
10048 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
10049 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10050 bfd_boolean rel_reloc;
10051
10052 rel_reloc = (NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
10053 && mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
10054 relocs, rel));
10055 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
10056 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
10057
10058 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
10059 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
10060 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
10061 {
10062 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
10063 h = NULL;
10064 }
10065 else
10066 {
10067 unsigned long extsymoff;
10068
10069 extsymoff = 0;
10070 if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
10071 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10072 h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
10073 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10074 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10075 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10076
10077 sec = NULL;
10078 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10079 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10080 sec = h->root.u.def.section;
10081 }
10082
10083 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
10084 {
10085 mips_reloc_against_discarded_section (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
10086 input_section, &rel, &relend,
10087 rel_reloc, howto, contents);
10088 continue;
10089 }
10090
10091 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
10092 {
10093 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
10094 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
10095 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
10096 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
10097 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
10098 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
10099 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
10100
10101 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
10102 of the reloc. */
10103 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10104 rel->r_offset += 4;
10105 }
10106
10107 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
10108 {
10109 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
10110 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
10111 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
10112 RELA relocation. */
10113 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
10114 relocs, rel))
10115 {
10116 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
10117 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel,
10118 howto, contents);
10119 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
10120 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type)
10121 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
10122 local_sections)))
10123 {
10124 if (!mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel, relend,
10125 contents, &addend))
10126 {
10127 if (h)
10128 name = h->root.root.string;
10129 else
10130 name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
10131 local_syms + r_symndx,
10132 sec);
10133 _bfd_error_handler
10134 /* xgettext:c-format */
10135 (_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
10136 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
10137 rel->r_offset);
10138 }
10139 }
10140 else
10141 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
10142 }
10143 else
10144 addend = rel->r_addend;
10145 mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
10146 local_syms, local_sections, rel);
10147 }
10148
10149 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
10150 {
10151 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
10152 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10153 rel->r_offset -= 4;
10154
10155 if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
10156 {
10157 addend += rel->r_addend;
10158 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type))
10159 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
10160 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
10161 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
10162 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
10163 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
10164 else
10165 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
10166
10167 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
10168 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
10169 source of the addend in the final link. */
10170 addend &= howto->src_mask;
10171
10172 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
10173 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
10174 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
10175 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
10176 but for endianness. */
10177 {
10178 bfd_vma sign_bits;
10179 bfd_vma low_bits;
10180 bfd_vma high_bits;
10181
10182 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
10183 #ifdef BFD64
10184 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
10185 #else
10186 sign_bits = -1;
10187 #endif
10188 else
10189 sign_bits = 0;
10190
10191 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
10192 do two separate stores. */
10193 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10194 {
10195 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
10196 first. */
10197 low_bits = sign_bits;
10198 high_bits = addend;
10199 }
10200 else
10201 {
10202 low_bits = addend;
10203 high_bits = sign_bits;
10204 }
10205 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
10206 contents + rel->r_offset);
10207 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
10208 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
10209 continue;
10210 }
10211
10212 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
10213 input_bfd, input_section,
10214 contents, FALSE))
10215 return FALSE;
10216 }
10217
10218 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
10219 continue;
10220 }
10221
10222 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
10223 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
10224 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
10225 for the next. */
10226 if (rel + 1 < relend
10227 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
10228 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
10229 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
10230 else
10231 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
10232
10233 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
10234 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
10235 input_section, info, rel,
10236 addend, howto, local_syms,
10237 local_sections, &value,
10238 &name, &cross_mode_jump_p,
10239 use_saved_addend_p))
10240 {
10241 case bfd_reloc_continue:
10242 /* There's nothing to do. */
10243 continue;
10244
10245 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
10246 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
10247 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
10248 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
10249 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
10250 continue;
10251
10252 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
10253 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
10254 info->callbacks->warning
10255 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
10256 return FALSE;
10257
10258 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
10259 if (use_saved_addend_p)
10260 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
10261 a given location. */
10262 ;
10263 else
10264 {
10265 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10266
10267 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10268 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10269 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
10270 if (!htab->small_data_overflow_reported
10271 && (gprel16_reloc_p (howto->type)
10272 || literal_reloc_p (howto->type)))
10273 {
10274 msg = _("small-data section exceeds 64KB;"
10275 " lower small-data size limit (see option -G)");
10276
10277 htab->small_data_overflow_reported = TRUE;
10278 (*info->callbacks->einfo) ("%P: %s\n", msg);
10279 }
10280 (*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
10281 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
10282 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
10283 }
10284 break;
10285
10286 case bfd_reloc_ok:
10287 break;
10288
10289 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
10290 msg = NULL;
10291 if (jal_reloc_p (howto->type))
10292 msg = (cross_mode_jump_p
10293 ? _("Cannot convert a jump to JALX "
10294 "for a non-word-aligned address")
10295 : (howto->type == R_MIPS16_26
10296 ? _("Jump to a non-word-aligned address")
10297 : _("Jump to a non-instruction-aligned address")));
10298 else if (b_reloc_p (howto->type))
10299 msg = (cross_mode_jump_p
10300 ? _("Cannot convert a branch to JALX "
10301 "for a non-word-aligned address")
10302 : _("Branch to a non-instruction-aligned address"));
10303 else if (aligned_pcrel_reloc_p (howto->type))
10304 msg = _("PC-relative load from unaligned address");
10305 if (msg)
10306 {
10307 info->callbacks->einfo
10308 ("%X%H: %s\n", input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, msg);
10309 break;
10310 }
10311 /* Fall through. */
10312
10313 default:
10314 abort ();
10315 break;
10316 }
10317
10318 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
10319 until we reach the last one. */
10320 if (use_saved_addend_p)
10321 {
10322 addend = value;
10323 continue;
10324 }
10325
10326 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
10327 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
10328 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
10329 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
10330 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
10331 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
10332 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
10333 only a 32-bit VMA. */
10334 {
10335 bfd_vma sign_bits;
10336 bfd_vma low_bits;
10337 bfd_vma high_bits;
10338
10339 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
10340 #ifdef BFD64
10341 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
10342 #else
10343 sign_bits = -1;
10344 #endif
10345 else
10346 sign_bits = 0;
10347
10348 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
10349 do two separate stores. */
10350 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10351 {
10352 /* Undo what we did above. */
10353 rel->r_offset -= 4;
10354 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
10355 first. */
10356 low_bits = sign_bits;
10357 high_bits = value;
10358 }
10359 else
10360 {
10361 low_bits = value;
10362 high_bits = sign_bits;
10363 }
10364 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
10365 contents + rel->r_offset);
10366 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
10367 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
10368 continue;
10369 }
10370
10371 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
10372 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
10373 input_bfd, input_section,
10374 contents, cross_mode_jump_p))
10375 return FALSE;
10376 }
10377
10378 return TRUE;
10379 }
10380 \f
10381 /* A function that iterates over each entry in la25_stubs and fills
10382 in the code for each one. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info. */
10383
10384 static int
10385 mips_elf_create_la25_stub (void **slot, void *data)
10386 {
10387 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
10388 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10389 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub;
10390 asection *s;
10391 bfd_byte *loc;
10392 bfd_vma offset, target, target_high, target_low;
10393
10394 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
10395 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
10396 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (hti->info);
10397 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10398
10399 /* Create the section contents, if we haven't already. */
10400 s = stub->stub_section;
10401 loc = s->contents;
10402 if (loc == NULL)
10403 {
10404 loc = bfd_malloc (s->size);
10405 if (loc == NULL)
10406 {
10407 hti->error = TRUE;
10408 return FALSE;
10409 }
10410 s->contents = loc;
10411 }
10412
10413 /* Work out where in the section this stub should go. */
10414 offset = stub->offset;
10415
10416 /* Work out the target address. */
10417 target = mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &s);
10418 target += s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10419
10420 target_high = ((target + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
10421 target_low = (target & 0xffff);
10422
10423 if (stub->stub_section != htab->strampoline)
10424 {
10425 /* This is a simple LUI/ADDIU stub. Zero out the beginning
10426 of the section and write the two instructions at the end. */
10427 memset (loc, 0, offset);
10428 loc += offset;
10429 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
10430 {
10431 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10432 LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS (target_high),
10433 loc);
10434 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10435 LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS (target_low),
10436 loc + 4);
10437 }
10438 else
10439 {
10440 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
10441 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 4);
10442 }
10443 }
10444 else
10445 {
10446 /* This is trampoline. */
10447 loc += offset;
10448 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
10449 {
10450 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10451 LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS (target_high), loc);
10452 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10453 LA25_J_MICROMIPS (target), loc + 4);
10454 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10455 LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS (target_low), loc + 8);
10456 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, 0, loc + 12);
10457 }
10458 else
10459 {
10460 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
10461 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_J (target), loc + 4);
10462 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 8);
10463 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, 0, loc + 12);
10464 }
10465 }
10466 return TRUE;
10467 }
10468
10469 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
10470 adjust it appropriately now. */
10471
10472 static void
10473 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10474 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
10475 {
10476 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
10477 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
10478 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
10479 "_ftext",
10480 "_etext",
10481 "__dso_displacement",
10482 "__elf_header",
10483 "__program_header_table",
10484 NULL
10485 };
10486
10487 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
10488 "_fdata",
10489 "_edata",
10490 "_end",
10491 "_fbss",
10492 NULL
10493 };
10494
10495 const char* const *p;
10496 int i;
10497
10498 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
10499 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
10500 *p;
10501 ++p)
10502 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
10503 {
10504 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
10505 IRIX6 linker. */
10506 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10507 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
10508
10509 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
10510 if (i == 0)
10511 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
10512 else
10513 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
10514
10515 break;
10516 }
10517 }
10518
10519 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
10520 dynamic sections here. */
10521
10522 bfd_boolean
10523 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
10524 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10525 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
10526 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
10527 {
10528 bfd *dynobj;
10529 asection *sgot;
10530 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
10531 const char *name;
10532 int idx;
10533 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10534 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
10535
10536 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10537 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10538 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10539 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
10540
10541 BFD_ASSERT (!htab->is_vxworks);
10542
10543 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
10544 && (h->plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE
10545 || h->plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE))
10546 {
10547 /* We've decided to create a PLT entry for this symbol. */
10548 bfd_byte *loc;
10549 bfd_vma header_address, got_address;
10550 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low, load;
10551 bfd_vma got_index;
10552 bfd_vma isa_bit;
10553
10554 got_index = h->plt.plist->gotplt_index;
10555
10556 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10557 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10558 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.splt != NULL);
10559 BFD_ASSERT (got_index != MINUS_ONE);
10560 BFD_ASSERT (!h->def_regular);
10561
10562 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
10563 isa_bit = htab->plt_header_is_comp;
10564 header_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
10565 + htab->root.splt->output_offset + isa_bit);
10566
10567 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
10568 got_address = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
10569 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset
10570 + got_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
10571
10572 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
10573 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
10574
10575 /* Initially point the .got.plt entry at the PLT header. */
10576 loc = (htab->root.sgotplt->contents + got_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
10577 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
10578 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
10579 else
10580 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
10581
10582 /* Now handle the PLT itself. First the standard entry (the order
10583 does not matter, we just have to pick one). */
10584 if (h->plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
10585 {
10586 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
10587 bfd_vma plt_offset;
10588
10589 plt_offset = htab->plt_header_size + h->plt.plist->mips_offset;
10590
10591 BFD_ASSERT (plt_offset <= htab->root.splt->size);
10592
10593 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
10594 loc = htab->root.splt->contents + plt_offset;
10595
10596 /* Pick the load opcode. */
10597 load = MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD (output_bfd);
10598
10599 /* Fill in the PLT entry itself. */
10600
10601 if (MIPSR6_P (output_bfd))
10602 plt_entry = mipsr6_exec_plt_entry;
10603 else
10604 plt_entry = mips_exec_plt_entry;
10605 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_address_high, loc);
10606 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_address_low | load,
10607 loc + 4);
10608
10609 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd))
10610 {
10611 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low, loc + 8);
10612 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
10613 }
10614 else
10615 {
10616 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 8);
10617 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low,
10618 loc + 12);
10619 }
10620 }
10621
10622 /* Now the compressed entry. They come after any standard ones. */
10623 if (h->plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE)
10624 {
10625 bfd_vma plt_offset;
10626
10627 plt_offset = (htab->plt_header_size + htab->plt_mips_offset
10628 + h->plt.plist->comp_offset);
10629
10630 BFD_ASSERT (plt_offset <= htab->root.splt->size);
10631
10632 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
10633 loc = htab->root.splt->contents + plt_offset;
10634
10635 /* Fill in the PLT entry itself. */
10636 if (!MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd))
10637 {
10638 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry;
10639
10640 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], loc);
10641 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], loc + 2);
10642 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
10643 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 6);
10644 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
10645 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 10);
10646 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, got_address, loc + 12);
10647 }
10648 else if (htab->insn32)
10649 {
10650 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry;
10651
10652 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], loc);
10653 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, got_address_high, loc + 2);
10654 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
10655 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, got_address_low, loc + 6);
10656 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
10657 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 10);
10658 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 12);
10659 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, got_address_low, loc + 14);
10660 }
10661 else
10662 {
10663 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry;
10664 bfd_signed_vma gotpc_offset;
10665 bfd_vma loc_address;
10666
10667 BFD_ASSERT (got_address % 4 == 0);
10668
10669 loc_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
10670 + htab->root.splt->output_offset + plt_offset);
10671 gotpc_offset = got_address - ((loc_address | 3) ^ 3);
10672
10673 /* ADDIUPC has a span of +/-16MB, check we're in range. */
10674 if (gotpc_offset + 0x1000000 >= 0x2000000)
10675 {
10676 _bfd_error_handler
10677 /* xgettext:c-format */
10678 (_("%B: `%A' offset of %ld from `%A' "
10679 "beyond the range of ADDIUPC"),
10680 output_bfd,
10681 htab->root.sgotplt->output_section,
10682 htab->root.splt->output_section,
10683 (long) gotpc_offset);
10684 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_error);
10685 return FALSE;
10686 }
10687 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd,
10688 plt_entry[0] | ((gotpc_offset >> 18) & 0x7f), loc);
10689 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, (gotpc_offset >> 2) & 0xffff, loc + 2);
10690 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
10691 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 6);
10692 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
10693 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 10);
10694 }
10695 }
10696
10697 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
10698 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, htab->root.srelplt,
10699 got_index - 2, h->dynindx,
10700 R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT, got_address);
10701
10702 /* We distinguish between PLT entries and lazy-binding stubs by
10703 giving the former an st_other value of STO_MIPS_PLT. Set the
10704 flag and leave the value if there are any relocations in the
10705 binary where pointer equality matters. */
10706 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
10707 if (h->pointer_equality_needed)
10708 sym->st_other = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS_PLT (sym->st_other);
10709 else
10710 {
10711 sym->st_value = 0;
10712 sym->st_other = 0;
10713 }
10714 }
10715
10716 if (h->plt.plist != NULL && h->plt.plist->stub_offset != MINUS_ONE)
10717 {
10718 /* We've decided to create a lazy-binding stub. */
10719 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd);
10720 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
10721 bfd_vma stub_size = htab->function_stub_size;
10722 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
10723 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
10724 bfd_vma stub_big_size;
10725
10726 if (!micromips_p)
10727 stub_big_size = MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE;
10728 else if (htab->insn32)
10729 stub_big_size = MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE;
10730 else
10731 stub_big_size = MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE;
10732
10733 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
10734
10735 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10736
10737 BFD_ASSERT (stub_size == stub_big_size || h->dynindx <= 0xffff);
10738
10739 /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed. Larger values would cause
10740 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
10741 index value. */
10742 if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
10743 return FALSE;
10744
10745 /* Fill the stub. */
10746 if (micromips_p)
10747 {
10748 idx = 0;
10749 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW_MICROMIPS (output_bfd),
10750 stub + idx);
10751 idx += 4;
10752 if (htab->insn32)
10753 {
10754 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
10755 STUB_MOVE32_MICROMIPS, stub + idx);
10756 idx += 4;
10757 }
10758 else
10759 {
10760 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE_MICROMIPS, stub + idx);
10761 idx += 2;
10762 }
10763 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
10764 {
10765 long dynindx_hi = (h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff;
10766
10767 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
10768 STUB_LUI_MICROMIPS (dynindx_hi),
10769 stub + idx);
10770 idx += 4;
10771 }
10772 if (htab->insn32)
10773 {
10774 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR32_MICROMIPS,
10775 stub + idx);
10776 idx += 4;
10777 }
10778 else
10779 {
10780 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR_MICROMIPS, stub + idx);
10781 idx += 2;
10782 }
10783
10784 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
10785 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
10786 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
10787 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
10788 STUB_ORI_MICROMIPS (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
10789 stub + idx);
10790 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
10791 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
10792 STUB_LI16U_MICROMIPS (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
10793 stub + idx);
10794 else
10795 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
10796 STUB_LI16S_MICROMIPS (output_bfd,
10797 h->dynindx),
10798 stub + idx);
10799 }
10800 else
10801 {
10802 idx = 0;
10803 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
10804 idx += 4;
10805 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE, stub + idx);
10806 idx += 4;
10807 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
10808 {
10809 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
10810 stub + idx);
10811 idx += 4;
10812 }
10813 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
10814 idx += 4;
10815
10816 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
10817 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
10818 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
10819 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
10820 stub + idx);
10821 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
10822 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
10823 stub + idx);
10824 else
10825 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
10826 stub + idx);
10827 }
10828
10829 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.plist->stub_offset <= htab->sstubs->size);
10830 memcpy (htab->sstubs->contents + h->plt.plist->stub_offset,
10831 stub, stub_size);
10832
10833 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. stub_offset != -1 occurs
10834 only for the referenced symbol. */
10835 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
10836
10837 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
10838 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
10839 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
10840 sym->st_value = (htab->sstubs->output_section->vma
10841 + htab->sstubs->output_offset
10842 + h->plt.plist->stub_offset
10843 + isa_bit);
10844 sym->st_other = other;
10845 }
10846
10847 /* If we have a MIPS16 function with a stub, the dynamic symbol must
10848 refer to the stub, since only the stub uses the standard calling
10849 conventions. */
10850 if (h->dynindx != -1 && hmips->fn_stub != NULL)
10851 {
10852 BFD_ASSERT (hmips->need_fn_stub);
10853 sym->st_value = (hmips->fn_stub->output_section->vma
10854 + hmips->fn_stub->output_offset);
10855 sym->st_size = hmips->fn_stub->size;
10856 sym->st_other = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (sym->st_other);
10857 }
10858
10859 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
10860 || h->forced_local);
10861
10862 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
10863 g = htab->got_info;
10864 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
10865
10866 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
10867 the symbols that need them. */
10868 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
10869 {
10870 bfd_vma offset;
10871 bfd_vma value;
10872
10873 value = sym->st_value;
10874 offset = mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (output_bfd, info, h);
10875 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
10876 }
10877
10878 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE && g->next)
10879 {
10880 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
10881 bfd_vma entry;
10882 bfd_vma offset;
10883
10884 gg = g;
10885
10886 e.abfd = output_bfd;
10887 e.symndx = -1;
10888 e.d.h = hmips;
10889 e.tls_type = GOT_TLS_NONE;
10890
10891 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
10892 {
10893 if (g->got_entries
10894 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
10895 &e)))
10896 {
10897 offset = p->gotidx;
10898 BFD_ASSERT (offset > 0 && offset < htab->root.sgot->size);
10899 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
10900 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
10901 && p->d.h != NULL
10902 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
10903 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
10904 {
10905 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
10906 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
10907 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
10908 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
10909 appropriate addend. */
10910 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
10911
10912 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
10913 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
10914 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
10915 else
10916 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
10917 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
10918
10919 entry = 0;
10920 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
10921 (output_bfd, info, rel,
10922 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
10923 return FALSE;
10924 }
10925 else
10926 entry = sym->st_value;
10927 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
10928 }
10929 }
10930 }
10931
10932 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
10933 name = h->root.root.string;
10934 if (h == elf_hash_table (info)->hdynamic
10935 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
10936 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10937 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
10938 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
10939 {
10940 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10941 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10942 sym->st_value = 1;
10943 }
10944 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
10945 {
10946 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10947 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10948 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
10949 }
10950 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
10951 {
10952 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
10953 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
10954 {
10955 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10956 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
10957 sym->st_value = 0;
10958 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
10959 }
10960 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
10961 {
10962 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10963 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
10964 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
10965 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
10966 }
10967 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
10968 {
10969 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
10970 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
10971 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
10972 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
10973 }
10974 }
10975
10976 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
10977 if (h->needs_copy)
10978 {
10979 asection *s;
10980 bfd_vma symval;
10981
10982 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10983 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10984
10985 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10986 symval = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
10987 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
10988 + h->root.u.def.value);
10989 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, s, s->reloc_count++,
10990 h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY, symval);
10991 }
10992
10993 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
10994 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
10995 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
10996
10997 /* Keep dynamic compressed symbols odd. This allows the dynamic linker
10998 to treat compressed symbols like any other. */
10999 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
11000 {
11001 BFD_ASSERT (sym->st_value & 1);
11002 sym->st_other -= STO_MIPS16;
11003 }
11004 else if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym->st_other))
11005 {
11006 BFD_ASSERT (sym->st_value & 1);
11007 sym->st_other -= STO_MICROMIPS;
11008 }
11009
11010 return TRUE;
11011 }
11012
11013 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
11014
11015 bfd_boolean
11016 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
11017 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11018 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11019 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11020 {
11021 bfd *dynobj;
11022 asection *sgot;
11023 struct mips_got_info *g;
11024 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11025 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
11026
11027 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11028 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11029 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
11030 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
11031
11032 if (h->plt.plist != NULL && h->plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
11033 {
11034 bfd_byte *loc;
11035 bfd_vma plt_address, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
11036 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
11037 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
11038 bfd_vma gotplt_index;
11039 bfd_vma plt_offset;
11040
11041 plt_offset = htab->plt_header_size + h->plt.plist->mips_offset;
11042 gotplt_index = h->plt.plist->gotplt_index;
11043
11044 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
11045 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.splt != NULL);
11046 BFD_ASSERT (gotplt_index != MINUS_ONE);
11047 BFD_ASSERT (plt_offset <= htab->root.splt->size);
11048
11049 /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry. */
11050 plt_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
11051 + htab->root.splt->output_offset
11052 + plt_offset);
11053
11054 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
11055 got_address = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
11056 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset
11057 + gotplt_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
11058
11059 /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
11060 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
11061 got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
11062
11063 /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
11064 entry. The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt. */
11065 branch_offset = -(plt_offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
11066
11067 /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry. */
11068 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
11069 (htab->root.sgotplt->contents
11070 + gotplt_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd)));
11071
11072 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
11073 loc = htab->root.splt->contents + plt_offset;
11074
11075 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
11076 {
11077 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
11078 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
11079 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_index, loc + 4);
11080 }
11081 else
11082 {
11083 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
11084
11085 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
11086 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
11087 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
11088
11089 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
11090 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_index, loc + 4);
11091 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
11092 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
11093 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
11094 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
11095 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
11096 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
11097
11098 loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
11099 + (gotplt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
11100
11101 /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry. */
11102 rel.r_offset = got_address;
11103 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
11104 rel.r_addend = plt_offset;
11105 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11106
11107 /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>). */
11108 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11109 rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
11110 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
11111 rel.r_addend = got_offset;
11112 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11113
11114 /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>). */
11115 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11116 rel.r_offset += 4;
11117 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
11118 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11119 }
11120
11121 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
11122 loc = (htab->root.srelplt->contents
11123 + gotplt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
11124 rel.r_offset = got_address;
11125 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
11126 rel.r_addend = 0;
11127 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11128
11129 if (!h->def_regular)
11130 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
11131 }
11132
11133 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
11134
11135 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
11136 g = htab->got_info;
11137 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
11138
11139 /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT. */
11140 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
11141 {
11142 bfd_vma offset;
11143 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
11144 bfd_byte *loc;
11145 asection *s;
11146
11147 /* Install the symbol value in the GOT. */
11148 offset = mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (output_bfd, info, h);
11149 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
11150
11151 /* Add a dynamic relocation for it. */
11152 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
11153 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
11154 outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
11155 + sgot->output_offset
11156 + offset);
11157 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
11158 outrel.r_addend = 0;
11159 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
11160 }
11161
11162 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
11163 if (h->needs_copy)
11164 {
11165 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
11166 asection *srel;
11167 bfd_byte *loc;
11168
11169 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
11170
11171 rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
11172 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
11173 + h->root.u.def.value);
11174 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
11175 rel.r_addend = 0;
11176 if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->root.sdynrelro)
11177 srel = htab->root.sreldynrelro;
11178 else
11179 srel = htab->root.srelbss;
11180 loc = srel->contents + srel->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11181 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11182 ++srel->reloc_count;
11183 }
11184
11185 /* If this is a mips16/microMIPS symbol, force the value to be even. */
11186 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
11187 sym->st_value &= ~1;
11188
11189 return TRUE;
11190 }
11191
11192 /* Write out a plt0 entry to the beginning of .plt. */
11193
11194 static bfd_boolean
11195 mips_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
11196 {
11197 bfd_byte *loc;
11198 bfd_vma gotplt_value, gotplt_value_high, gotplt_value_low;
11199 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
11200 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11201
11202 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11203 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11204
11205 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
11206 plt_entry = mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry;
11207 else if (ABI_N32_P (output_bfd))
11208 plt_entry = mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry;
11209 else if (!htab->plt_header_is_comp)
11210 plt_entry = mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry;
11211 else if (htab->insn32)
11212 plt_entry = micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry;
11213 else
11214 plt_entry = micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry;
11215
11216 /* Calculate the value of .got.plt. */
11217 gotplt_value = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
11218 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset);
11219 gotplt_value_high = ((gotplt_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
11220 gotplt_value_low = gotplt_value & 0xffff;
11221
11222 /* The PLT sequence is not safe for N64 if .got.plt's address can
11223 not be loaded in two instructions. */
11224 BFD_ASSERT ((gotplt_value & ~(bfd_vma) 0x7fffffff) == 0
11225 || ~(gotplt_value | 0x7fffffff) == 0);
11226
11227 /* Install the PLT header. */
11228 loc = htab->root.splt->contents;
11229 if (plt_entry == micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
11230 {
11231 bfd_vma gotpc_offset;
11232 bfd_vma loc_address;
11233 size_t i;
11234
11235 BFD_ASSERT (gotplt_value % 4 == 0);
11236
11237 loc_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
11238 + htab->root.splt->output_offset);
11239 gotpc_offset = gotplt_value - ((loc_address | 3) ^ 3);
11240
11241 /* ADDIUPC has a span of +/-16MB, check we're in range. */
11242 if (gotpc_offset + 0x1000000 >= 0x2000000)
11243 {
11244 _bfd_error_handler
11245 /* xgettext:c-format */
11246 (_("%B: `%A' offset of %ld from `%A' beyond the range of ADDIUPC"),
11247 output_bfd,
11248 htab->root.sgotplt->output_section,
11249 htab->root.splt->output_section,
11250 (long) gotpc_offset);
11251 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_error);
11252 return FALSE;
11253 }
11254 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd,
11255 plt_entry[0] | ((gotpc_offset >> 18) & 0x7f), loc);
11256 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, (gotpc_offset >> 2) & 0xffff, loc + 2);
11257 for (i = 2; i < ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry); i++)
11258 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[i], loc + (i * 2));
11259 }
11260 else if (plt_entry == micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
11261 {
11262 size_t i;
11263
11264 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], loc);
11265 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, gotplt_value_high, loc + 2);
11266 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
11267 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, gotplt_value_low, loc + 6);
11268 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
11269 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, gotplt_value_low, loc + 10);
11270 for (i = 6; i < ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry); i++)
11271 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[i], loc + (i * 2));
11272 }
11273 else
11274 {
11275 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | gotplt_value_high, loc);
11276 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 4);
11277 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 8);
11278 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
11279 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
11280 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
11281 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
11282 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
11283 }
11284
11285 return TRUE;
11286 }
11287
11288 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
11289 contents of .rela.plt.unloaded. */
11290
11291 static void
11292 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
11293 {
11294 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
11295 bfd_byte *loc;
11296 bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
11297 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
11298 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11299
11300 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11301 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11302
11303 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
11304
11305 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
11306 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
11307 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
11308 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
11309
11310 got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
11311 got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
11312
11313 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
11314 plt_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
11315 + htab->root.splt->output_offset);
11316
11317 /* Install the PLT header. */
11318 loc = htab->root.splt->contents;
11319 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
11320 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
11321 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
11322 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
11323 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
11324 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
11325
11326 /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
11327 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
11328 rela.r_offset = plt_address;
11329 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
11330 rela.r_addend = 0;
11331 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
11332 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11333
11334 /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
11335 %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
11336 rela.r_offset += 4;
11337 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
11338 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
11339 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11340
11341 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
11342 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
11343 in which symbols were output. */
11344 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
11345 {
11346 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
11347
11348 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
11349 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
11350 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11351 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11352
11353 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
11354 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
11355 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11356 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11357
11358 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
11359 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
11360 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11361 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11362 }
11363 }
11364
11365 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library. */
11366
11367 static void
11368 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
11369 {
11370 unsigned int i;
11371 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11372
11373 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11374 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11375
11376 /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte. */
11377 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
11378 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
11379 htab->root.splt->contents + i * 4);
11380 }
11381
11382 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
11383
11384 bfd_boolean
11385 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
11386 struct bfd_link_info *info)
11387 {
11388 bfd *dynobj;
11389 asection *sdyn;
11390 asection *sgot;
11391 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
11392 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11393
11394 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11395 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11396
11397 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
11398
11399 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
11400
11401 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
11402 gg = htab->got_info;
11403
11404 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
11405 {
11406 bfd_byte *b;
11407 int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
11408
11409 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
11410 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
11411
11412 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (output_bfd, FALSE);
11413 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
11414
11415 for (b = sdyn->contents;
11416 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
11417 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
11418 {
11419 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
11420 const char *name;
11421 size_t elemsize;
11422 asection *s;
11423 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
11424
11425 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
11426 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
11427
11428 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
11429 swap_out_p = TRUE;
11430
11431 switch (dyn.d_tag)
11432 {
11433 case DT_RELENT:
11434 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
11435 break;
11436
11437 case DT_RELAENT:
11438 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
11439 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
11440 break;
11441
11442 case DT_STRSZ:
11443 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
11444 dyn.d_un.d_val =
11445 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
11446 break;
11447
11448 case DT_PLTGOT:
11449 s = htab->root.sgot;
11450 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
11451 break;
11452
11453 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
11454 s = htab->root.sgotplt;
11455 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
11456 break;
11457
11458 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
11459 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
11460 break;
11461
11462 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
11463 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
11464 break;
11465
11466 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
11467 {
11468 time_t t;
11469 time (&t);
11470 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
11471 }
11472 break;
11473
11474 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
11475 /* XXX FIXME: */
11476 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11477 break;
11478
11479 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
11480 /* XXX FIXME: */
11481 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11482 break;
11483
11484 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
11485 s = output_bfd->sections;
11486 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
11487 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
11488 break;
11489
11490 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
11491 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
11492 break;
11493
11494 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
11495 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
11496 entry of the first external symbol that is not
11497 referenced within the same object. */
11498 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
11499 break;
11500
11501 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
11502 if (htab->global_gotsym)
11503 {
11504 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->global_gotsym->dynindx;
11505 break;
11506 }
11507 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
11508 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
11509 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO. */
11510 /* Fall through. */
11511
11512 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
11513 name = ".dynsym";
11514 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
11515 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, name);
11516
11517 if (s != NULL)
11518 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
11519 else
11520 dyn.d_un.d_val = 0;
11521 break;
11522
11523 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
11524 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
11525 break;
11526
11527 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
11528 {
11529 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11530 h = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol;
11531 if (!h)
11532 {
11533 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
11534 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11535 break;
11536 }
11537 s = h->root.u.def.section;
11538
11539 /* The MIPS_RLD_MAP tag stores the absolute address of the
11540 debug pointer. */
11541 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
11542 + h->root.u.def.value);
11543 }
11544 break;
11545
11546 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL:
11547 {
11548 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11549 bfd_vma dt_addr, rld_addr;
11550 h = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol;
11551 if (!h)
11552 {
11553 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
11554 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11555 break;
11556 }
11557 s = h->root.u.def.section;
11558
11559 /* The MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL tag stores the offset to the debug
11560 pointer, relative to the address of the tag. */
11561 dt_addr = (sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset
11562 + (b - sdyn->contents));
11563 rld_addr = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
11564 + h->root.u.def.value);
11565 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = rld_addr - dt_addr;
11566 }
11567 break;
11568
11569 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
11570 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
11571 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
11572 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
11573 break;
11574
11575 case DT_PLTREL:
11576 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
11577 if (htab->is_vxworks)
11578 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
11579 else
11580 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_REL;
11581 break;
11582
11583 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
11584 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
11585 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->root.srelplt->size;
11586 break;
11587
11588 case DT_JMPREL:
11589 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
11590 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (htab->root.srelplt->output_section->vma
11591 + htab->root.srelplt->output_offset);
11592 break;
11593
11594 case DT_TEXTREL:
11595 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
11596 the dynamic tag. */
11597 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
11598 {
11599 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
11600 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11601 }
11602 break;
11603
11604 case DT_FLAGS:
11605 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
11606 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS. */
11607 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
11608 dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
11609 else
11610 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11611 break;
11612
11613 default:
11614 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11615 if (htab->is_vxworks
11616 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
11617 swap_out_p = TRUE;
11618 break;
11619 }
11620
11621 if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
11622 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
11623 (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
11624
11625 if (dyn_to_skip)
11626 {
11627 dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
11628 dyn_to_skip = 0;
11629 }
11630 }
11631
11632 /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag. */
11633 if (dyn_skipped > 0)
11634 memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
11635 }
11636
11637 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0
11638 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sgot->output_section))
11639 {
11640 if (htab->is_vxworks)
11641 {
11642 /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
11643 ".dynamic" section. The second is initialized by the
11644 loader and contains the shared library identifier.
11645 The third is also initialized by the loader and points
11646 to the lazy resolution stub. */
11647 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
11648 sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
11649 sgot->contents);
11650 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
11651 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
11652 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
11653 sgot->contents
11654 + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
11655 }
11656 else
11657 {
11658 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
11659 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
11660 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
11661 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
11662 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
11663 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
11664 }
11665
11666 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
11667 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
11668 }
11669
11670 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
11671 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
11672 {
11673 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
11674 bfd_vma addend = 0;
11675
11676 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
11677 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
11678
11679 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
11680 {
11681 bfd_vma got_index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
11682 + g->next->tls_gotno;
11683
11684 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
11685 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
11686 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
11687 sgot->contents
11688 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
11689
11690 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
11691 continue;
11692
11693 for (; got_index < g->local_gotno; got_index++)
11694 {
11695 if (got_index >= g->assigned_low_gotno
11696 && got_index <= g->assigned_high_gotno)
11697 continue;
11698
11699 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
11700 = got_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
11701 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
11702 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
11703 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
11704 0, &addend, sgot)))
11705 return FALSE;
11706 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
11707 }
11708 }
11709 }
11710
11711 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
11712 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
11713 here. */
11714
11715 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
11716 {
11717 bfd_byte *b;
11718 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
11719
11720 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
11721
11722 for (b = sdyn->contents;
11723 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
11724 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
11725 {
11726 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
11727 asection *s;
11728
11729 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
11730 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
11731
11732 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
11733 swap_out_p = TRUE;
11734
11735 switch (dyn.d_tag)
11736 {
11737 case DT_RELSZ:
11738 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
11739 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
11740 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
11741 are trailing null entries. */
11742 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
11743 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
11744 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
11745 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
11746 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
11747 /* Adjust the section size too. Tools like the prelinker
11748 can reasonably expect the values to the same. */
11749 elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
11750 = dyn.d_un.d_val;
11751 break;
11752
11753 default:
11754 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11755 break;
11756 }
11757
11758 if (swap_out_p)
11759 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
11760 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
11761 }
11762 }
11763
11764 {
11765 asection *s;
11766 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
11767
11768 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
11769 {
11770 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
11771 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
11772 if (s != NULL)
11773 {
11774 cpt.id1 = 1;
11775 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
11776 cpt.id2 = 2;
11777 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
11778 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
11779 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
11780 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
11781 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
11782 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
11783 s->contents));
11784
11785 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
11786 if (htab->sstubs != NULL)
11787 {
11788 file_ptr dummy_offset;
11789
11790 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
11791 dummy_offset = htab->sstubs->size - htab->function_stub_size;
11792 memset (htab->sstubs->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
11793 htab->function_stub_size);
11794 }
11795 }
11796 }
11797
11798 /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
11799 increasing order of r_symndx. The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
11800 this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
11801 relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful. */
11802 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
11803 {
11804 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
11805 if (s != NULL
11806 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
11807 {
11808 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
11809
11810 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
11811 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
11812 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
11813 sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
11814 else
11815 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
11816 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
11817 sort_dynamic_relocs);
11818 }
11819 }
11820 }
11821
11822 if (htab->root.splt && htab->root.splt->size > 0)
11823 {
11824 if (htab->is_vxworks)
11825 {
11826 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
11827 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
11828 else
11829 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
11830 }
11831 else
11832 {
11833 BFD_ASSERT (!bfd_link_pic (info));
11834 if (!mips_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info))
11835 return FALSE;
11836 }
11837 }
11838 return TRUE;
11839 }
11840
11841
11842 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
11843
11844 static void
11845 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
11846 {
11847 flagword val;
11848
11849 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
11850 {
11851 default:
11852 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
11853 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
11854 break;
11855
11856 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
11857 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
11858 break;
11859
11860 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
11861 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
11862 break;
11863
11864 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
11865 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
11866 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
11867 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
11868 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
11869 break;
11870
11871 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
11872 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
11873 break;
11874
11875 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
11876 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
11877 break;
11878
11879 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
11880 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
11881 break;
11882
11883 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
11884 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
11885 break;
11886
11887 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
11888 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
11889 break;
11890
11891 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
11892 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
11893 break;
11894
11895 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
11896 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
11897 break;
11898
11899 case bfd_mach_mips5900:
11900 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_5900;
11901 break;
11902
11903 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
11904 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
11905 break;
11906
11907 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
11908 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
11909 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
11910 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
11911 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
11912 case bfd_mach_mips14000:
11913 case bfd_mach_mips16000:
11914 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
11915 break;
11916
11917 case bfd_mach_mips5:
11918 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
11919 break;
11920
11921 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e:
11922 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E;
11923 break;
11924
11925 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f:
11926 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F;
11927 break;
11928
11929 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
11930 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
11931 break;
11932
11933 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a:
11934 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A;
11935 break;
11936
11937 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
11938 case bfd_mach_mips_octeonp:
11939 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
11940 break;
11941
11942 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon3:
11943 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON3;
11944 break;
11945
11946 case bfd_mach_mips_xlr:
11947 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_XLR;
11948 break;
11949
11950 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon2:
11951 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2;
11952 break;
11953
11954 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
11955 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
11956 break;
11957
11958 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
11959 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
11960 break;
11961
11962 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
11963 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r3:
11964 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r5:
11965 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
11966 break;
11967
11968 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
11969 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r3:
11970 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r5:
11971 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
11972 break;
11973
11974 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r6:
11975 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6;
11976 break;
11977
11978 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r6:
11979 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6;
11980 break;
11981 }
11982 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
11983 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
11984
11985 }
11986
11987
11988 /* Whether to sort relocs output by ld -r or ld --emit-relocs, by r_offset.
11989 Don't do so for code sections. We want to keep ordering of HI16/LO16
11990 as is. On the other hand, elf-eh-frame.c processing requires .eh_frame
11991 relocs to be sorted. */
11992
11993 bfd_boolean
11994 _bfd_mips_elf_sort_relocs_p (asection *sec)
11995 {
11996 return (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0;
11997 }
11998
11999
12000 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
12001 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
12002 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
12003
12004 void
12005 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
12006 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12007 {
12008 unsigned int i;
12009 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
12010 const char *name;
12011 asection *sec;
12012
12013 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
12014 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
12015 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
12016 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
12017 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
12018
12019 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
12020 info for each special section. */
12021 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
12022 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
12023 i++, hdrpp++)
12024 {
12025 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
12026 {
12027 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
12028 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
12029 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
12030 if (sec != NULL)
12031 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12032 break;
12033
12034 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
12035 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
12036 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
12037 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
12038 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
12039 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
12040 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
12041 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12042 break;
12043
12044 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
12045 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
12046 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
12047 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
12048 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
12049 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12050 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
12051 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
12052 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12053 break;
12054
12055 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
12056 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
12057 if (sec != NULL)
12058 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12059 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
12060 if (sec != NULL)
12061 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12062 break;
12063
12064 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
12065 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
12066 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
12067 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
12068 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
12069 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12070 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
12071 else
12072 {
12073 BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
12074 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12075 (name
12076 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
12077 }
12078 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
12079 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12080 break;
12081
12082 }
12083 }
12084 }
12085 \f
12086 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
12087 segments. */
12088
12089 int
12090 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
12091 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12092 {
12093 asection *s;
12094 int ret = 0;
12095
12096 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
12097 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
12098 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
12099 ++ret;
12100
12101 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS segment. */
12102 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".MIPS.abiflags"))
12103 ++ret;
12104
12105 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
12106 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
12107 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12108 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
12109 ++ret;
12110
12111 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
12112 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
12113 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
12114 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
12115 ++ret;
12116
12117 /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects. See
12118 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details. */
12119 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
12120 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
12121 ++ret;
12122
12123 return ret;
12124 }
12125
12126 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
12127
12128 bfd_boolean
12129 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
12130 struct bfd_link_info *info)
12131 {
12132 asection *s;
12133 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
12134 bfd_size_type amt;
12135
12136 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
12137 segment. */
12138 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
12139 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
12140 {
12141 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
12142 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
12143 break;
12144 if (m == NULL)
12145 {
12146 amt = sizeof *m;
12147 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12148 if (m == NULL)
12149 return FALSE;
12150
12151 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
12152 m->count = 1;
12153 m->sections[0] = s;
12154
12155 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
12156 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12157 while (*pm != NULL
12158 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
12159 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
12160 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12161
12162 m->next = *pm;
12163 *pm = m;
12164 }
12165 }
12166
12167 /* If there is a .MIPS.abiflags section, we need a PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS
12168 segment. */
12169 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".MIPS.abiflags");
12170 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
12171 {
12172 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
12173 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS)
12174 break;
12175 if (m == NULL)
12176 {
12177 amt = sizeof *m;
12178 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12179 if (m == NULL)
12180 return FALSE;
12181
12182 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS;
12183 m->count = 1;
12184 m->sections[0] = s;
12185
12186 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
12187 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12188 while (*pm != NULL
12189 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
12190 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
12191 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12192
12193 m->next = *pm;
12194 *pm = m;
12195 }
12196 }
12197
12198 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
12199 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
12200 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
12201 table. */
12202 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
12203 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
12204 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
12205 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
12206 now. */
12207 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
12208 {
12209 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
12210 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
12211 break;
12212
12213 if (s)
12214 {
12215 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
12216
12217 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12218 while (*pm != NULL
12219 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
12220 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
12221 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12222
12223 if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
12224 {
12225 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
12226 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12227 options_segment->next = *pm;
12228 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
12229 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
12230 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
12231 options_segment->count = 1;
12232 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
12233 *pm = options_segment;
12234 }
12235 }
12236 }
12237 else
12238 {
12239 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
12240 {
12241 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
12242 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
12243 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
12244 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
12245 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
12246 {
12247 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
12248 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
12249 break;
12250 if (m == NULL)
12251 {
12252 amt = sizeof *m;
12253 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12254 if (m == NULL)
12255 return FALSE;
12256
12257 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
12258
12259 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
12260 if (s == NULL)
12261 {
12262 m->count = 0;
12263 m->p_flags = 0;
12264 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
12265 }
12266 else
12267 {
12268 m->count = 1;
12269 m->sections[0] = s;
12270 }
12271
12272 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
12273 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12274 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
12275 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12276 if (*pm != NULL)
12277 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12278
12279 m->next = *pm;
12280 *pm = m;
12281 }
12282 }
12283 }
12284 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
12285 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
12286 between. */
12287 for (pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd); *pm != NULL;
12288 pm = &(*pm)->next)
12289 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
12290 break;
12291 m = *pm;
12292 /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
12293 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
12294 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
12295 arrays of that size. An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
12296 be actively harmful in such cases. Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
12297 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
12298 which might move one of the other sections to a different
12299 PT_LOAD segment. */
12300 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
12301 && m != NULL
12302 && m->count == 1
12303 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
12304 {
12305 static const char *sec_names[] =
12306 {
12307 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
12308 };
12309 bfd_vma low, high;
12310 unsigned int i, c;
12311 struct elf_segment_map *n;
12312
12313 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
12314 high = 0;
12315 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
12316 {
12317 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
12318 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
12319 {
12320 bfd_size_type sz;
12321
12322 if (low > s->vma)
12323 low = s->vma;
12324 sz = s->size;
12325 if (high < s->vma + sz)
12326 high = s->vma + sz;
12327 }
12328 }
12329
12330 c = 0;
12331 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12332 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
12333 && s->vma >= low
12334 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
12335 ++c;
12336
12337 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
12338 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12339 if (n == NULL)
12340 return FALSE;
12341 *n = *m;
12342 n->count = c;
12343
12344 i = 0;
12345 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12346 {
12347 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
12348 && s->vma >= low
12349 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
12350 {
12351 n->sections[i] = s;
12352 ++i;
12353 }
12354 }
12355
12356 *pm = n;
12357 }
12358 }
12359
12360 /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
12361 like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
12362
12363 If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
12364 standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
12365 the new (writable) segment. However, the MIPS ABI requires
12366 .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
12367 start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
12368
12369 Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
12370 writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
12371 header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
12372 There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
12373 so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
12374 extension.
12375
12376 If INFO is NULL, we may be copying an already prelinked binary
12377 with objcopy or strip, so do not add this header. */
12378 if (info != NULL
12379 && !SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
12380 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
12381 {
12382 for (pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd); *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
12383 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
12384 break;
12385 if (*pm == NULL)
12386 {
12387 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
12388 if (m == NULL)
12389 return FALSE;
12390
12391 m->p_type = PT_NULL;
12392 *pm = m;
12393 }
12394 }
12395
12396 return TRUE;
12397 }
12398 \f
12399 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
12400 relocation. */
12401
12402 asection *
12403 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
12404 struct bfd_link_info *info,
12405 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
12406 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
12407 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
12408 {
12409 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
12410
12411 if (h != NULL)
12412 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
12413 {
12414 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
12415 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
12416 return NULL;
12417 }
12418
12419 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
12420 }
12421
12422 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
12423
12424 bfd_boolean
12425 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12426 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12427 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12428 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12429 {
12430 #if 0
12431 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12432 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
12433 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
12434 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
12435 unsigned long r_symndx;
12436 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12437
12438 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
12439 return TRUE;
12440
12441 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
12442 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
12443 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
12444
12445 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
12446 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
12447 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
12448 {
12449 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
12450 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
12451 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
12452 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
12453 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
12454 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
12455 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
12456 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
12457 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
12458 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
12459 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
12460 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
12461 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
12462 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
12463 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
12464 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
12465 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
12466 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
12467 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
12468 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
12469 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
12470 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
12471 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
12472 break;
12473
12474 default:
12475 break;
12476 }
12477 #endif
12478
12479 return TRUE;
12480 }
12481
12482 /* Prevent .MIPS.abiflags from being discarded with --gc-sections. */
12483
12484 bfd_boolean
12485 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_extra_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12486 elf_gc_mark_hook_fn gc_mark_hook)
12487 {
12488 bfd *sub;
12489
12490 _bfd_elf_gc_mark_extra_sections (info, gc_mark_hook);
12491
12492 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub != NULL; sub = sub->link.next)
12493 {
12494 asection *o;
12495
12496 if (! is_mips_elf (sub))
12497 continue;
12498
12499 for (o = sub->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
12500 if (!o->gc_mark
12501 && MIPS_ELF_ABIFLAGS_SECTION_NAME_P
12502 (bfd_get_section_name (sub, o)))
12503 {
12504 if (!_bfd_elf_gc_mark (info, o, gc_mark_hook))
12505 return FALSE;
12506 }
12507 }
12508
12509 return TRUE;
12510 }
12511 \f
12512 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
12513 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
12514 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
12515 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
12516
12517 void
12518 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12519 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
12520 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
12521 {
12522 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
12523
12524 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
12525
12526 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
12527 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
12528 /* Any absolute non-dynamic relocations against an indirect or weak
12529 definition will be against the target symbol. */
12530 if (indmips->has_static_relocs)
12531 dirmips->has_static_relocs = TRUE;
12532
12533 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12534 return;
12535
12536 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
12537 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
12538 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
12539 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
12540 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
12541 if (indmips->fn_stub)
12542 {
12543 dirmips->fn_stub = indmips->fn_stub;
12544 indmips->fn_stub = NULL;
12545 }
12546 if (indmips->need_fn_stub)
12547 {
12548 dirmips->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
12549 indmips->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
12550 }
12551 if (indmips->call_stub)
12552 {
12553 dirmips->call_stub = indmips->call_stub;
12554 indmips->call_stub = NULL;
12555 }
12556 if (indmips->call_fp_stub)
12557 {
12558 dirmips->call_fp_stub = indmips->call_fp_stub;
12559 indmips->call_fp_stub = NULL;
12560 }
12561 if (indmips->global_got_area < dirmips->global_got_area)
12562 dirmips->global_got_area = indmips->global_got_area;
12563 if (indmips->global_got_area < GGA_NONE)
12564 indmips->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
12565 if (indmips->has_nonpic_branches)
12566 dirmips->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
12567 }
12568 \f
12569 #define PDR_SIZE 32
12570
12571 bfd_boolean
12572 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
12573 struct bfd_link_info *info)
12574 {
12575 asection *o;
12576 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
12577 unsigned char *tdata;
12578 size_t i, skip;
12579
12580 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
12581 if (! o)
12582 return FALSE;
12583 if (o->size == 0)
12584 return FALSE;
12585 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
12586 return FALSE;
12587 if (o->output_section != NULL
12588 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
12589 return FALSE;
12590
12591 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
12592 if (! tdata)
12593 return FALSE;
12594
12595 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
12596 info->keep_memory);
12597 if (!cookie->rels)
12598 {
12599 free (tdata);
12600 return FALSE;
12601 }
12602
12603 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
12604 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
12605
12606 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
12607 {
12608 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
12609 {
12610 tdata[i] = 1;
12611 skip ++;
12612 }
12613 }
12614
12615 if (skip != 0)
12616 {
12617 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
12618 if (o->rawsize == 0)
12619 o->rawsize = o->size;
12620 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
12621 ret = TRUE;
12622 }
12623 else
12624 free (tdata);
12625
12626 if (! info->keep_memory)
12627 free (cookie->rels);
12628
12629 return ret;
12630 }
12631
12632 bfd_boolean
12633 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
12634 {
12635 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
12636 return TRUE;
12637 return FALSE;
12638 }
12639
12640 bfd_boolean
12641 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
12642 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12643 asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
12644 {
12645 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
12646 int i;
12647
12648 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
12649 return FALSE;
12650
12651 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
12652 return FALSE;
12653
12654 to = contents;
12655 end = contents + sec->size;
12656 for (from = contents, i = 0;
12657 from < end;
12658 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
12659 {
12660 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
12661 continue;
12662 if (to != from)
12663 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
12664 to += PDR_SIZE;
12665 }
12666 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
12667 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
12668 return TRUE;
12669 }
12670 \f
12671 /* microMIPS code retains local labels for linker relaxation. Omit them
12672 from output by default for clarity. */
12673
12674 bfd_boolean
12675 _bfd_mips_elf_is_target_special_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
12676 {
12677 return _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (abfd, sym->name);
12678 }
12679
12680 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
12681 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
12682
12683 struct mips_elf_find_line
12684 {
12685 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
12686 struct ecoff_find_line i;
12687 };
12688
12689 bfd_boolean
12690 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols,
12691 asection *section, bfd_vma offset,
12692 const char **filename_ptr,
12693 const char **functionname_ptr,
12694 unsigned int *line_ptr,
12695 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
12696 {
12697 asection *msec;
12698
12699 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
12700 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
12701 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
12702 dwarf_debug_sections,
12703 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
12704 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
12705 return TRUE;
12706
12707 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
12708 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
12709 line_ptr))
12710 return TRUE;
12711
12712 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
12713 if (msec != NULL)
12714 {
12715 flagword origflags;
12716 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
12717 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
12718 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
12719
12720 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
12721 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
12722 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
12723 origflags = msec->flags;
12724 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
12725 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
12726
12727 fi = mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
12728 if (fi == NULL)
12729 {
12730 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
12731 char *fraw_src;
12732 char *fraw_end;
12733 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
12734 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
12735
12736 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12737 if (fi == NULL)
12738 {
12739 msec->flags = origflags;
12740 return FALSE;
12741 }
12742
12743 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
12744 {
12745 msec->flags = origflags;
12746 return FALSE;
12747 }
12748
12749 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
12750 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
12751 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
12752 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
12753 {
12754 msec->flags = origflags;
12755 return FALSE;
12756 }
12757 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
12758 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
12759 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
12760 fraw_end = (fraw_src
12761 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
12762 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
12763 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
12764
12765 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
12766
12767 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
12768 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
12769 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
12770 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
12771 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
12772 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
12773 }
12774
12775 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
12776 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
12777 line_ptr))
12778 {
12779 msec->flags = origflags;
12780 return TRUE;
12781 }
12782
12783 msec->flags = origflags;
12784 }
12785
12786 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
12787
12788 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
12789 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
12790 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr);
12791 }
12792
12793 bfd_boolean
12794 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
12795 const char **filename_ptr,
12796 const char **functionname_ptr,
12797 unsigned int *line_ptr)
12798 {
12799 bfd_boolean found;
12800 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
12801 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
12802 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
12803 return found;
12804 }
12805
12806 \f
12807 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
12808 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
12809 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
12810
12811 bfd_boolean
12812 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
12813 const void *location,
12814 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
12815 {
12816 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
12817 {
12818 bfd_byte *c;
12819
12820 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
12821 {
12822 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
12823 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12824 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
12825 return FALSE;
12826 }
12827 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
12828 if (c == NULL)
12829 {
12830 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
12831 if (c == NULL)
12832 return FALSE;
12833 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
12834 }
12835
12836 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
12837 }
12838
12839 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
12840 count);
12841 }
12842
12843 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
12844 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
12845
12846 bfd_byte *
12847 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
12848 (bfd *abfd,
12849 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
12850 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
12851 bfd_byte *data,
12852 bfd_boolean relocatable,
12853 asymbol **symbols)
12854 {
12855 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
12856 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
12857 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
12858 bfd_size_type sz;
12859
12860 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
12861 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
12862 long reloc_count;
12863
12864 if (reloc_size < 0)
12865 goto error_return;
12866
12867 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
12868 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
12869 goto error_return;
12870
12871 /* read in the section */
12872 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
12873 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
12874 goto error_return;
12875
12876 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
12877 input_section,
12878 reloc_vector,
12879 symbols);
12880 if (reloc_count < 0)
12881 goto error_return;
12882
12883 if (reloc_count > 0)
12884 {
12885 arelent **parent;
12886 /* for mips */
12887 int gp_found;
12888 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
12889
12890 {
12891 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
12892 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
12893 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
12894 if (abfd && input_bfd
12895 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
12896 lh = 0;
12897 else
12898 {
12899 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
12900 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
12901 }
12902 lookup:
12903 if (lh)
12904 {
12905 switch (lh->type)
12906 {
12907 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
12908 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
12909 case bfd_link_hash_common:
12910 gp_found = 0;
12911 break;
12912 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
12913 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
12914 gp_found = 1;
12915 gp = lh->u.def.value;
12916 break;
12917 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
12918 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
12919 lh = lh->u.i.link;
12920 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
12921 goto lookup;
12922 case bfd_link_hash_new:
12923 default:
12924 abort ();
12925 }
12926 }
12927 else
12928 gp_found = 0;
12929 }
12930 /* end mips */
12931 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
12932 {
12933 char *error_message = NULL;
12934 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
12935
12936 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
12937 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
12938 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
12939
12940 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
12941 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
12942 to the generic handling. */
12943 if (gp_found
12944 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
12945 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
12946 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
12947 input_section, relocatable,
12948 data, gp);
12949 else
12950 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
12951 input_section,
12952 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
12953 &error_message);
12954
12955 if (relocatable)
12956 {
12957 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
12958
12959 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
12960 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
12961 os->reloc_count++;
12962 }
12963
12964 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
12965 {
12966 switch (r)
12967 {
12968 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
12969 (*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
12970 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
12971 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE);
12972 break;
12973 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
12974 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
12975 (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
12976 (link_info, error_message,
12977 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address);
12978 break;
12979 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
12980 (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
12981 (link_info, NULL,
12982 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
12983 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
12984 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address);
12985 break;
12986 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
12987 default:
12988 abort ();
12989 break;
12990 }
12991
12992 }
12993 }
12994 }
12995 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
12996 free (reloc_vector);
12997 return data;
12998
12999 error_return:
13000 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
13001 free (reloc_vector);
13002 return NULL;
13003 }
13004 \f
13005 static bfd_boolean
13006 mips_elf_relax_delete_bytes (bfd *abfd,
13007 asection *sec, bfd_vma addr, int count)
13008 {
13009 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13010 unsigned int sec_shndx;
13011 bfd_byte *contents;
13012 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
13013 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
13014 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
13015 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
13016 struct elf_link_hash_entry **end_hashes;
13017 struct elf_link_hash_entry **start_hashes;
13018 unsigned int symcount;
13019
13020 sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
13021 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
13022
13023 irel = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs;
13024 irelend = irel + sec->reloc_count;
13025
13026 /* Actually delete the bytes. */
13027 memmove (contents + addr, contents + addr + count,
13028 (size_t) (sec->size - addr - count));
13029 sec->size -= count;
13030
13031 /* Adjust all the relocs. */
13032 for (irel = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
13033 {
13034 /* Get the new reloc address. */
13035 if (irel->r_offset > addr)
13036 irel->r_offset -= count;
13037 }
13038
13039 BFD_ASSERT (addr % 2 == 0);
13040 BFD_ASSERT (count % 2 == 0);
13041
13042 /* Adjust the local symbols defined in this section. */
13043 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
13044 isym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
13045 for (isymend = isym + symtab_hdr->sh_info; isym < isymend; isym++)
13046 if (isym->st_shndx == sec_shndx && isym->st_value > addr)
13047 isym->st_value -= count;
13048
13049 /* Now adjust the global symbols defined in this section. */
13050 symcount = (symtab_hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Sym)
13051 - symtab_hdr->sh_info);
13052 sym_hashes = start_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
13053 end_hashes = sym_hashes + symcount;
13054
13055 for (; sym_hashes < end_hashes; sym_hashes++)
13056 {
13057 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym_hash = *sym_hashes;
13058
13059 if ((sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13060 || sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13061 && sym_hash->root.u.def.section == sec)
13062 {
13063 bfd_vma value = sym_hash->root.u.def.value;
13064
13065 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym_hash->other))
13066 value &= MINUS_TWO;
13067 if (value > addr)
13068 sym_hash->root.u.def.value -= count;
13069 }
13070 }
13071
13072 return TRUE;
13073 }
13074
13075
13076 /* Opcodes needed for microMIPS relaxation as found in
13077 opcodes/micromips-opc.c. */
13078
13079 struct opcode_descriptor {
13080 unsigned long match;
13081 unsigned long mask;
13082 };
13083
13084 /* The $ra register aka $31. */
13085
13086 #define RA 31
13087
13088 /* 32-bit instruction format register fields. */
13089
13090 #define OP32_SREG(opcode) (((opcode) >> 16) & 0x1f)
13091 #define OP32_TREG(opcode) (((opcode) >> 21) & 0x1f)
13092
13093 /* Check if a 5-bit register index can be abbreviated to 3 bits. */
13094
13095 #define OP16_VALID_REG(r) \
13096 ((2 <= (r) && (r) <= 7) || (16 <= (r) && (r) <= 17))
13097
13098
13099 /* 32-bit and 16-bit branches. */
13100
13101 static const struct opcode_descriptor b_insns_32[] = {
13102 { /* "b", "p", */ 0x40400000, 0xffff0000 }, /* bgez 0 */
13103 { /* "b", "p", */ 0x94000000, 0xffff0000 }, /* beq 0, 0 */
13104 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13105 };
13106
13107 static const struct opcode_descriptor bc_insn_32 =
13108 { /* "bc(1|2)(ft)", "N,p", */ 0x42800000, 0xfec30000 };
13109
13110 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insn_32 =
13111 { /* "b(g|l)(e|t)z", "s,p", */ 0x40000000, 0xff200000 };
13112
13113 static const struct opcode_descriptor bzal_insn_32 =
13114 { /* "b(ge|lt)zal", "s,p", */ 0x40200000, 0xffa00000 };
13115
13116 static const struct opcode_descriptor beq_insn_32 =
13117 { /* "b(eq|ne)", "s,t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xdc000000 };
13118
13119 static const struct opcode_descriptor b_insn_16 =
13120 { /* "b", "mD", */ 0xcc00, 0xfc00 };
13121
13122 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insn_16 =
13123 { /* "b(eq|ne)z", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xdc00 };
13124
13125
13126 /* 32-bit and 16-bit branch EQ and NE zero. */
13127
13128 /* NOTE: All opcode tables have BEQ/BNE in the same order: first the
13129 eq and second the ne. This convention is used when replacing a
13130 32-bit BEQ/BNE with the 16-bit version. */
13131
13132 #define BZC32_REG_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) << 16)
13133
13134 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_rs_insns_32[] = {
13135 { /* "beqz", "s,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xffe00000 },
13136 { /* "bnez", "s,p", */ 0xb4000000, 0xffe00000 },
13137 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13138 };
13139
13140 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_rt_insns_32[] = {
13141 { /* "beqz", "t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xfc01f000 },
13142 { /* "bnez", "t,p", */ 0xb4000000, 0xfc01f000 },
13143 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13144 };
13145
13146 static const struct opcode_descriptor bzc_insns_32[] = {
13147 { /* "beqzc", "s,p", */ 0x40e00000, 0xffe00000 },
13148 { /* "bnezc", "s,p", */ 0x40a00000, 0xffe00000 },
13149 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13150 };
13151
13152 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insns_16[] = {
13153 { /* "beqz", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xfc00 },
13154 { /* "bnez", "md,mE", */ 0xac00, 0xfc00 },
13155 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13156 };
13157
13158 /* Switch between a 5-bit register index and its 3-bit shorthand. */
13159
13160 #define BZ16_REG(opcode) ((((((opcode) >> 7) & 7) + 0x1e) & 0xf) + 2)
13161 #define BZ16_REG_FIELD(r) (((r) & 7) << 7)
13162
13163
13164 /* 32-bit instructions with a delay slot. */
13165
13166 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_insn_32_bd16 =
13167 { /* "jals", "a", */ 0x74000000, 0xfc000000 };
13168
13169 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_insn_32_bd32 =
13170 { /* "jal", "a", */ 0xf4000000, 0xfc000000 };
13171
13172 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_x_insn_32_bd32 =
13173 { /* "jal[x]", "a", */ 0xf0000000, 0xf8000000 };
13174
13175 static const struct opcode_descriptor j_insn_32 =
13176 { /* "j", "a", */ 0xd4000000, 0xfc000000 };
13177
13178 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_32 =
13179 { /* "jalr[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00000f3c, 0xfc00efff };
13180
13181 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
13182
13183 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_32_bd16[] = {
13184 { /* "jals", "a", */ 0x74000000, 0xfc000000 },
13185
13186 { /* "jalrs[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00004f3c, 0xfc00efff },
13187 { /* "b(ge|lt)zals", "s,p", */ 0x42200000, 0xffa00000 },
13188
13189 { /* "b(g|l)(e|t)z", "s,p", */ 0x40000000, 0xff200000 },
13190 { /* "b(eq|ne)", "s,t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xdc000000 },
13191 { /* "j", "a", */ 0xd4000000, 0xfc000000 },
13192 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13193 };
13194
13195 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
13196
13197 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_32_bd32[] = {
13198 { /* "jal[x]", "a", */ 0xf0000000, 0xf8000000 },
13199
13200 { /* "jalr[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00000f3c, 0xfc00efff },
13201 { /* "b(ge|lt)zal", "s,p", */ 0x40200000, 0xffa00000 },
13202 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13203 };
13204
13205
13206 /* 16-bit instructions with a delay slot. */
13207
13208 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_16_bd16 =
13209 { /* "jalrs", "my,mj", */ 0x45e0, 0xffe0 };
13210
13211 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_16_bd32 =
13212 { /* "jalr", "my,mj", */ 0x45c0, 0xffe0 };
13213
13214 static const struct opcode_descriptor jr_insn_16 =
13215 { /* "jr", "mj", */ 0x4580, 0xffe0 };
13216
13217 #define JR16_REG(opcode) ((opcode) & 0x1f)
13218
13219 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
13220
13221 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_16_bd16[] = {
13222 { /* "jalrs", "my,mj", */ 0x45e0, 0xffe0 },
13223
13224 { /* "b", "mD", */ 0xcc00, 0xfc00 },
13225 { /* "b(eq|ne)z", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xdc00 },
13226 { /* "jr", "mj", */ 0x4580, 0xffe0 },
13227 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13228 };
13229
13230
13231 /* LUI instruction. */
13232
13233 static const struct opcode_descriptor lui_insn =
13234 { /* "lui", "s,u", */ 0x41a00000, 0xffe00000 };
13235
13236
13237 /* ADDIU instruction. */
13238
13239 static const struct opcode_descriptor addiu_insn =
13240 { /* "addiu", "t,r,j", */ 0x30000000, 0xfc000000 };
13241
13242 static const struct opcode_descriptor addiupc_insn =
13243 { /* "addiu", "mb,$pc,mQ", */ 0x78000000, 0xfc000000 };
13244
13245 #define ADDIUPC_REG_FIELD(r) \
13246 (((2 <= (r) && (r) <= 7) ? (r) : ((r) - 16)) << 23)
13247
13248
13249 /* Relaxable instructions in a JAL delay slot: MOVE. */
13250
13251 /* The 16-bit move has rd in 9:5 and rs in 4:0. The 32-bit moves
13252 (ADDU, OR) have rd in 15:11 and rs in 10:16. */
13253 #define MOVE32_RD(opcode) (((opcode) >> 11) & 0x1f)
13254 #define MOVE32_RS(opcode) (((opcode) >> 16) & 0x1f)
13255
13256 #define MOVE16_RD_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) << 5)
13257 #define MOVE16_RS_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) )
13258
13259 static const struct opcode_descriptor move_insns_32[] = {
13260 { /* "move", "d,s", */ 0x00000290, 0xffe007ff }, /* or d,s,$0 */
13261 { /* "move", "d,s", */ 0x00000150, 0xffe007ff }, /* addu d,s,$0 */
13262 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13263 };
13264
13265 static const struct opcode_descriptor move_insn_16 =
13266 { /* "move", "mp,mj", */ 0x0c00, 0xfc00 };
13267
13268
13269 /* NOP instructions. */
13270
13271 static const struct opcode_descriptor nop_insn_32 =
13272 { /* "nop", "", */ 0x00000000, 0xffffffff };
13273
13274 static const struct opcode_descriptor nop_insn_16 =
13275 { /* "nop", "", */ 0x0c00, 0xffff };
13276
13277
13278 /* Instruction match support. */
13279
13280 #define MATCH(opcode, insn) ((opcode & insn.mask) == insn.match)
13281
13282 static int
13283 find_match (unsigned long opcode, const struct opcode_descriptor insn[])
13284 {
13285 unsigned long indx;
13286
13287 for (indx = 0; insn[indx].mask != 0; indx++)
13288 if (MATCH (opcode, insn[indx]))
13289 return indx;
13290
13291 return -1;
13292 }
13293
13294
13295 /* Branch and delay slot decoding support. */
13296
13297 /* If PTR points to what *might* be a 16-bit branch or jump, then
13298 return the minimum length of its delay slot, otherwise return 0.
13299 Non-zero results are not definitive as we might be checking against
13300 the second half of another instruction. */
13301
13302 static int
13303 check_br16_dslot (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr)
13304 {
13305 unsigned long opcode;
13306 int bdsize;
13307
13308 opcode = bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr);
13309 if (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd32) != 0)
13310 /* 16-bit branch/jump with a 32-bit delay slot. */
13311 bdsize = 4;
13312 else if (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd16) != 0
13313 || find_match (opcode, ds_insns_16_bd16) >= 0)
13314 /* 16-bit branch/jump with a 16-bit delay slot. */
13315 bdsize = 2;
13316 else
13317 /* No delay slot. */
13318 bdsize = 0;
13319
13320 return bdsize;
13321 }
13322
13323 /* If PTR points to what *might* be a 32-bit branch or jump, then
13324 return the minimum length of its delay slot, otherwise return 0.
13325 Non-zero results are not definitive as we might be checking against
13326 the second half of another instruction. */
13327
13328 static int
13329 check_br32_dslot (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr)
13330 {
13331 unsigned long opcode;
13332 int bdsize;
13333
13334 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13335 if (find_match (opcode, ds_insns_32_bd32) >= 0)
13336 /* 32-bit branch/jump with a 32-bit delay slot. */
13337 bdsize = 4;
13338 else if (find_match (opcode, ds_insns_32_bd16) >= 0)
13339 /* 32-bit branch/jump with a 16-bit delay slot. */
13340 bdsize = 2;
13341 else
13342 /* No delay slot. */
13343 bdsize = 0;
13344
13345 return bdsize;
13346 }
13347
13348 /* If PTR points to a 16-bit branch or jump with a 32-bit delay slot
13349 that doesn't fiddle with REG, then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
13350
13351 static bfd_boolean
13352 check_br16 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr, unsigned long reg)
13353 {
13354 unsigned long opcode;
13355
13356 opcode = bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr);
13357 if (MATCH (opcode, b_insn_16)
13358 /* B16 */
13359 || (MATCH (opcode, jr_insn_16) && reg != JR16_REG (opcode))
13360 /* JR16 */
13361 || (MATCH (opcode, bz_insn_16) && reg != BZ16_REG (opcode))
13362 /* BEQZ16, BNEZ16 */
13363 || (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd32)
13364 /* JALR16 */
13365 && reg != JR16_REG (opcode) && reg != RA))
13366 return TRUE;
13367
13368 return FALSE;
13369 }
13370
13371 /* If PTR points to a 32-bit branch or jump that doesn't fiddle with REG,
13372 then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
13373
13374 static bfd_boolean
13375 check_br32 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr, unsigned long reg)
13376 {
13377 unsigned long opcode;
13378
13379 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13380 if (MATCH (opcode, j_insn_32)
13381 /* J */
13382 || MATCH (opcode, bc_insn_32)
13383 /* BC1F, BC1T, BC2F, BC2T */
13384 || (MATCH (opcode, jal_x_insn_32_bd32) && reg != RA)
13385 /* JAL, JALX */
13386 || (MATCH (opcode, bz_insn_32) && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode))
13387 /* BGEZ, BGTZ, BLEZ, BLTZ */
13388 || (MATCH (opcode, bzal_insn_32)
13389 /* BGEZAL, BLTZAL */
13390 && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode) && reg != RA)
13391 || ((MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_32) || MATCH (opcode, beq_insn_32))
13392 /* JALR, JALR.HB, BEQ, BNE */
13393 && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode) && reg != OP32_TREG (opcode)))
13394 return TRUE;
13395
13396 return FALSE;
13397 }
13398
13399 /* If the instruction encoding at PTR and relocations [INTERNAL_RELOCS,
13400 IRELEND) at OFFSET indicate that there must be a compact branch there,
13401 then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
13402
13403 static bfd_boolean
13404 check_relocated_bzc (bfd *abfd, const bfd_byte *ptr, bfd_vma offset,
13405 const Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
13406 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irelend)
13407 {
13408 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
13409 unsigned long opcode;
13410
13411 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13412 if (find_match (opcode, bzc_insns_32) < 0)
13413 return FALSE;
13414
13415 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
13416 if (irel->r_offset == offset
13417 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1)
13418 return TRUE;
13419
13420 return FALSE;
13421 }
13422
13423 /* Bitsize checking. */
13424 #define IS_BITSIZE(val, N) \
13425 (((((val) & ((1ULL << (N)) - 1)) ^ (1ULL << ((N) - 1))) \
13426 - (1ULL << ((N) - 1))) == (val))
13427
13428 \f
13429 bfd_boolean
13430 _bfd_mips_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
13431 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
13432 bfd_boolean *again)
13433 {
13434 bfd_boolean insn32 = mips_elf_hash_table (link_info)->insn32;
13435 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13436 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
13437 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
13438 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
13439 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
13440
13441 /* Assume nothing changes. */
13442 *again = FALSE;
13443
13444 /* We don't have to do anything for a relocatable link, if
13445 this section does not have relocs, or if this is not a
13446 code section. */
13447
13448 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
13449 || (sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
13450 || sec->reloc_count == 0
13451 || (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
13452 return TRUE;
13453
13454 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
13455
13456 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
13457 internal_relocs = (_bfd_elf_link_read_relocs
13458 (abfd, sec, NULL, (Elf_Internal_Rela *) NULL,
13459 link_info->keep_memory));
13460 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
13461 goto error_return;
13462
13463 /* Walk through them looking for relaxing opportunities. */
13464 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
13465 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
13466 {
13467 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
13468 unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
13469 bfd_boolean target_is_micromips_code_p;
13470 unsigned long opcode;
13471 bfd_vma symval;
13472 bfd_vma pcrval;
13473 bfd_byte *ptr;
13474 int fndopc;
13475
13476 /* The number of bytes to delete for relaxation and from where
13477 to delete these bytes starting at irel->r_offset. */
13478 int delcnt = 0;
13479 int deloff = 0;
13480
13481 /* If this isn't something that can be relaxed, then ignore
13482 this reloc. */
13483 if (r_type != R_MICROMIPS_HI16
13484 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
13485 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
13486 continue;
13487
13488 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
13489 if (contents == NULL)
13490 {
13491 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
13492 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
13493 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
13494 /* Go get them off disk. */
13495 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
13496 goto error_return;
13497 }
13498 ptr = contents + irel->r_offset;
13499
13500 /* Read this BFD's local symbols if we haven't done so already. */
13501 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
13502 {
13503 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
13504 if (isymbuf == NULL)
13505 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
13506 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
13507 NULL, NULL, NULL);
13508 if (isymbuf == NULL)
13509 goto error_return;
13510 }
13511
13512 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
13513 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
13514 {
13515 /* A local symbol. */
13516 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
13517 asection *sym_sec;
13518
13519 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
13520 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
13521 sym_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
13522 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
13523 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
13524 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
13525 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
13526 else
13527 sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
13528 symval = (isym->st_value
13529 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
13530 + sym_sec->output_offset);
13531 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (isym->st_other);
13532 }
13533 else
13534 {
13535 unsigned long indx;
13536 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13537
13538 /* An external symbol. */
13539 indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
13540 h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
13541 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
13542
13543 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
13544 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13545 /* This appears to be a reference to an undefined
13546 symbol. Just ignore it -- it will be caught by the
13547 regular reloc processing. */
13548 continue;
13549
13550 symval = (h->root.u.def.value
13551 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
13552 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
13553 target_is_micromips_code_p = (!h->needs_plt
13554 && ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->other));
13555 }
13556
13557
13558 /* For simplicity of coding, we are going to modify the
13559 section contents, the section relocs, and the BFD symbol
13560 table. We must tell the rest of the code not to free up this
13561 information. It would be possible to instead create a table
13562 of changes which have to be made, as is done in coff-mips.c;
13563 that would be more work, but would require less memory when
13564 the linker is run. */
13565
13566 /* Only 32-bit instructions relaxed. */
13567 if (irel->r_offset + 4 > sec->size)
13568 continue;
13569
13570 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13571
13572 /* This is the pc-relative distance from the instruction the
13573 relocation is applied to, to the symbol referred. */
13574 pcrval = (symval
13575 - (sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset)
13576 - irel->r_offset);
13577
13578 /* R_MICROMIPS_HI16 / LUI relaxation to nil, performing relaxation
13579 of corresponding R_MICROMIPS_LO16 to R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16 or
13580 R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2. The R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2 condition is
13581
13582 (symval % 4 == 0 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval, 25))
13583
13584 where pcrval has first to be adjusted to apply against the LO16
13585 location (we make the adjustment later on, when we have figured
13586 out the offset). */
13587 if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16 && MATCH (opcode, lui_insn))
13588 {
13589 bfd_boolean bzc = FALSE;
13590 unsigned long nextopc;
13591 unsigned long reg;
13592 bfd_vma offset;
13593
13594 /* Give up if the previous reloc was a HI16 against this symbol
13595 too. */
13596 if (irel > internal_relocs
13597 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_HI16
13598 && ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info) == r_symndx)
13599 continue;
13600
13601 /* Or if the next reloc is not a LO16 against this symbol. */
13602 if (irel + 1 >= irelend
13603 || ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[1].r_info) != R_MICROMIPS_LO16
13604 || ELF32_R_SYM (irel[1].r_info) != r_symndx)
13605 continue;
13606
13607 /* Or if the second next reloc is a LO16 against this symbol too. */
13608 if (irel + 2 >= irelend
13609 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[2].r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
13610 && ELF32_R_SYM (irel[2].r_info) == r_symndx)
13611 continue;
13612
13613 /* See if the LUI instruction *might* be in a branch delay slot.
13614 We check whether what looks like a 16-bit branch or jump is
13615 actually an immediate argument to a compact branch, and let
13616 it through if so. */
13617 if (irel->r_offset >= 2
13618 && check_br16_dslot (abfd, ptr - 2)
13619 && !(irel->r_offset >= 4
13620 && (bzc = check_relocated_bzc (abfd,
13621 ptr - 4, irel->r_offset - 4,
13622 internal_relocs, irelend))))
13623 continue;
13624 if (irel->r_offset >= 4
13625 && !bzc
13626 && check_br32_dslot (abfd, ptr - 4))
13627 continue;
13628
13629 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode);
13630
13631 /* We only relax adjacent instructions or ones separated with
13632 a branch or jump that has a delay slot. The branch or jump
13633 must not fiddle with the register used to hold the address.
13634 Subtract 4 for the LUI itself. */
13635 offset = irel[1].r_offset - irel[0].r_offset;
13636 switch (offset - 4)
13637 {
13638 case 0:
13639 break;
13640 case 2:
13641 if (check_br16 (abfd, ptr + 4, reg))
13642 break;
13643 continue;
13644 case 4:
13645 if (check_br32 (abfd, ptr + 4, reg))
13646 break;
13647 continue;
13648 default:
13649 continue;
13650 }
13651
13652 nextopc = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, contents + irel[1].r_offset);
13653
13654 /* Give up unless the same register is used with both
13655 relocations. */
13656 if (OP32_SREG (nextopc) != reg)
13657 continue;
13658
13659 /* Now adjust pcrval, subtracting the offset to the LO16 reloc
13660 and rounding up to take masking of the two LSBs into account. */
13661 pcrval = ((pcrval - offset + 3) | 3) ^ 3;
13662
13663 /* R_MICROMIPS_LO16 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16. */
13664 if (IS_BITSIZE (symval, 16))
13665 {
13666 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
13667 irel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16);
13668
13669 /* Instructions using R_MICROMIPS_LO16 have the base or
13670 source register in bits 20:16. This register becomes $0
13671 (zero) as the result of the R_MICROMIPS_HI16 being 0. */
13672 nextopc &= ~0x001f0000;
13673 bfd_put_16 (abfd, (nextopc >> 16) & 0xffff,
13674 contents + irel[1].r_offset);
13675 }
13676
13677 /* R_MICROMIPS_LO16 / ADDIU relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2.
13678 We add 4 to take LUI deletion into account while checking
13679 the PC-relative distance. */
13680 else if (symval % 4 == 0
13681 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval + 4, 25)
13682 && MATCH (nextopc, addiu_insn)
13683 && OP32_TREG (nextopc) == OP32_SREG (nextopc)
13684 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_TREG (nextopc)))
13685 {
13686 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
13687 irel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2);
13688
13689 /* Replace ADDIU with the ADDIUPC version. */
13690 nextopc = (addiupc_insn.match
13691 | ADDIUPC_REG_FIELD (OP32_TREG (nextopc)));
13692
13693 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, nextopc,
13694 contents + irel[1].r_offset);
13695 }
13696
13697 /* Can't do anything, give up, sigh... */
13698 else
13699 continue;
13700
13701 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
13702 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MIPS_NONE);
13703
13704 /* Delete the LUI instruction: 4 bytes at irel->r_offset. */
13705 delcnt = 4;
13706 deloff = 0;
13707 }
13708
13709 /* Compact branch relaxation -- due to the multitude of macros
13710 employed by the compiler/assembler, compact branches are not
13711 always generated. Obviously, this can/will be fixed elsewhere,
13712 but there is no drawback in double checking it here. */
13713 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
13714 && irel->r_offset + 5 < sec->size
13715 && ((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rs_insns_32)) >= 0
13716 || (fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rt_insns_32)) >= 0)
13717 && ((!insn32
13718 && (delcnt = MATCH (bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr + 4),
13719 nop_insn_16) ? 2 : 0))
13720 || (irel->r_offset + 7 < sec->size
13721 && (delcnt = MATCH (bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd,
13722 ptr + 4),
13723 nop_insn_32) ? 4 : 0))))
13724 {
13725 unsigned long reg;
13726
13727 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode) ? OP32_SREG (opcode) : OP32_TREG (opcode);
13728
13729 /* Replace BEQZ/BNEZ with the compact version. */
13730 opcode = (bzc_insns_32[fndopc].match
13731 | BZC32_REG_FIELD (reg)
13732 | (opcode & 0xffff)); /* Addend value. */
13733
13734 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, opcode, ptr);
13735
13736 /* Delete the delay slot NOP: two or four bytes from
13737 irel->offset + 4; delcnt has already been set above. */
13738 deloff = 4;
13739 }
13740
13741 /* R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1. We need
13742 to check the distance from the next instruction, so subtract 2. */
13743 else if (!insn32
13744 && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
13745 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval - 2, 11)
13746 && find_match (opcode, b_insns_32) >= 0)
13747 {
13748 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
13749 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1);
13750
13751 /* Replace the 32-bit opcode with a 16-bit opcode. */
13752 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
13753 (b_insn_16.match
13754 | (opcode & 0x3ff)), /* Addend value. */
13755 ptr);
13756
13757 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 2. */
13758 delcnt = 2;
13759 deloff = 2;
13760 }
13761
13762 /* R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1. We need
13763 to check the distance from the next instruction, so subtract 2. */
13764 else if (!insn32
13765 && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
13766 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval - 2, 8)
13767 && (((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rs_insns_32)) >= 0
13768 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_SREG (opcode)))
13769 || ((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rt_insns_32)) >= 0
13770 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_TREG (opcode)))))
13771 {
13772 unsigned long reg;
13773
13774 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode) ? OP32_SREG (opcode) : OP32_TREG (opcode);
13775
13776 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
13777 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
13778
13779 /* Replace the 32-bit opcode with a 16-bit opcode. */
13780 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
13781 (bz_insns_16[fndopc].match
13782 | BZ16_REG_FIELD (reg)
13783 | (opcode & 0x7f)), /* Addend value. */
13784 ptr);
13785
13786 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 2. */
13787 delcnt = 2;
13788 deloff = 2;
13789 }
13790
13791 /* R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 -- JAL to JALS relaxation for microMIPS targets. */
13792 else if (!insn32
13793 && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
13794 && target_is_micromips_code_p
13795 && irel->r_offset + 7 < sec->size
13796 && MATCH (opcode, jal_insn_32_bd32))
13797 {
13798 unsigned long n32opc;
13799 bfd_boolean relaxed = FALSE;
13800
13801 n32opc = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr + 4);
13802
13803 if (MATCH (n32opc, nop_insn_32))
13804 {
13805 /* Replace delay slot 32-bit NOP with a 16-bit NOP. */
13806 bfd_put_16 (abfd, nop_insn_16.match, ptr + 4);
13807
13808 relaxed = TRUE;
13809 }
13810 else if (find_match (n32opc, move_insns_32) >= 0)
13811 {
13812 /* Replace delay slot 32-bit MOVE with 16-bit MOVE. */
13813 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
13814 (move_insn_16.match
13815 | MOVE16_RD_FIELD (MOVE32_RD (n32opc))
13816 | MOVE16_RS_FIELD (MOVE32_RS (n32opc))),
13817 ptr + 4);
13818
13819 relaxed = TRUE;
13820 }
13821 /* Other 32-bit instructions relaxable to 16-bit
13822 instructions will be handled here later. */
13823
13824 if (relaxed)
13825 {
13826 /* JAL with 32-bit delay slot that is changed to a JALS
13827 with 16-bit delay slot. */
13828 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, jal_insn_32_bd16.match, ptr);
13829
13830 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 6. */
13831 delcnt = 2;
13832 deloff = 6;
13833 }
13834 }
13835
13836 if (delcnt != 0)
13837 {
13838 /* Note that we've changed the relocs, section contents, etc. */
13839 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
13840 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
13841 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
13842
13843 /* Delete bytes depending on the delcnt and deloff. */
13844 if (!mips_elf_relax_delete_bytes (abfd, sec,
13845 irel->r_offset + deloff, delcnt))
13846 goto error_return;
13847
13848 /* That will change things, so we should relax again.
13849 Note that this is not required, and it may be slow. */
13850 *again = TRUE;
13851 }
13852 }
13853
13854 if (isymbuf != NULL
13855 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
13856 {
13857 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
13858 free (isymbuf);
13859 else
13860 {
13861 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
13862 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
13863 }
13864 }
13865
13866 if (contents != NULL
13867 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
13868 {
13869 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
13870 free (contents);
13871 else
13872 {
13873 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
13874 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
13875 }
13876 }
13877
13878 if (internal_relocs != NULL
13879 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
13880 free (internal_relocs);
13881
13882 return TRUE;
13883
13884 error_return:
13885 if (isymbuf != NULL
13886 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
13887 free (isymbuf);
13888 if (contents != NULL
13889 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
13890 free (contents);
13891 if (internal_relocs != NULL
13892 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
13893 free (internal_relocs);
13894
13895 return FALSE;
13896 }
13897 \f
13898 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
13899
13900 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
13901 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
13902 {
13903 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
13904 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
13905
13906 ret = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
13907 if (ret == NULL)
13908 return NULL;
13909
13910 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
13911 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
13912 sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry),
13913 MIPS_ELF_DATA))
13914 {
13915 free (ret);
13916 return NULL;
13917 }
13918 ret->root.init_plt_refcount.plist = NULL;
13919 ret->root.init_plt_offset.plist = NULL;
13920
13921 return &ret->root.root;
13922 }
13923
13924 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks. */
13925
13926 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
13927 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
13928 {
13929 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
13930
13931 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
13932 if (ret)
13933 {
13934 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
13935
13936 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
13937 htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
13938 htab->is_vxworks = TRUE;
13939 }
13940 return ret;
13941 }
13942
13943 /* A function that the linker calls if we are allowed to use PLTs
13944 and copy relocs. */
13945
13946 void
13947 _bfd_mips_elf_use_plts_and_copy_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
13948 {
13949 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
13950 }
13951
13952 /* A function that the linker calls to select between all or only
13953 32-bit microMIPS instructions, and between making or ignoring
13954 branch relocation checks for invalid transitions between ISA modes. */
13955
13956 void
13957 _bfd_mips_elf_linker_flags (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean insn32,
13958 bfd_boolean ignore_branch_isa)
13959 {
13960 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->insn32 = insn32;
13961 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->ignore_branch_isa = ignore_branch_isa;
13962 }
13963 \f
13964 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
13965
13966 struct mips_mach_extension
13967 {
13968 unsigned long extension, base;
13969 };
13970
13971
13972 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
13973 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
13974
13975 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] =
13976 {
13977 /* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
13978 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon3, bfd_mach_mips_octeon2 },
13979 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon2, bfd_mach_mips_octeonp },
13980 { bfd_mach_mips_octeonp, bfd_mach_mips_octeon },
13981 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
13982 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
13983
13984 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
13985 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
13986 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
13987 { bfd_mach_mips_xlr, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
13988
13989 /* MIPS V extensions. */
13990 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
13991
13992 /* R10000 extensions. */
13993 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
13994 { bfd_mach_mips14000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
13995 { bfd_mach_mips16000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
13996
13997 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
13998 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
13999 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
14000 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
14001 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
14002 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
14003 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
14004
14005 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
14006 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14007 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14008 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14009 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14010 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14011
14012 /* VR4100 extensions. */
14013 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
14014 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
14015
14016 /* MIPS III extensions. */
14017 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14018 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14019 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14020 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14021 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14022 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14023 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14024 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14025 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14026 { bfd_mach_mips5900, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14027
14028 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
14029 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
14030
14031 /* MIPS II extensions. */
14032 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
14033 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
14034
14035 /* MIPS I extensions. */
14036 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
14037 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
14038 };
14039
14040 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
14041
14042 static bfd_boolean
14043 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
14044 {
14045 size_t i;
14046
14047 if (extension == base)
14048 return TRUE;
14049
14050 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
14051 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
14052 return TRUE;
14053
14054 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
14055 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
14056 return TRUE;
14057
14058 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
14059 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
14060 {
14061 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
14062 if (extension == base)
14063 return TRUE;
14064 }
14065
14066 return FALSE;
14067 }
14068
14069 /* Return the BFD mach for each .MIPS.abiflags ISA Extension. */
14070
14071 static unsigned long
14072 bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (unsigned int isa_ext)
14073 {
14074 switch (isa_ext)
14075 {
14076 case AFL_EXT_3900: return bfd_mach_mips3900;
14077 case AFL_EXT_4010: return bfd_mach_mips4010;
14078 case AFL_EXT_4100: return bfd_mach_mips4100;
14079 case AFL_EXT_4111: return bfd_mach_mips4111;
14080 case AFL_EXT_4120: return bfd_mach_mips4120;
14081 case AFL_EXT_4650: return bfd_mach_mips4650;
14082 case AFL_EXT_5400: return bfd_mach_mips5400;
14083 case AFL_EXT_5500: return bfd_mach_mips5500;
14084 case AFL_EXT_5900: return bfd_mach_mips5900;
14085 case AFL_EXT_10000: return bfd_mach_mips10000;
14086 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2E: return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e;
14087 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2F: return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f;
14088 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_3A: return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a;
14089 case AFL_EXT_SB1: return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
14090 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON: return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
14091 case AFL_EXT_OCTEONP: return bfd_mach_mips_octeonp;
14092 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON2: return bfd_mach_mips_octeon2;
14093 case AFL_EXT_XLR: return bfd_mach_mips_xlr;
14094 default: return bfd_mach_mips3000;
14095 }
14096 }
14097
14098 /* Return the .MIPS.abiflags value representing each ISA Extension. */
14099
14100 unsigned int
14101 bfd_mips_isa_ext (bfd *abfd)
14102 {
14103 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
14104 {
14105 case bfd_mach_mips3900: return AFL_EXT_3900;
14106 case bfd_mach_mips4010: return AFL_EXT_4010;
14107 case bfd_mach_mips4100: return AFL_EXT_4100;
14108 case bfd_mach_mips4111: return AFL_EXT_4111;
14109 case bfd_mach_mips4120: return AFL_EXT_4120;
14110 case bfd_mach_mips4650: return AFL_EXT_4650;
14111 case bfd_mach_mips5400: return AFL_EXT_5400;
14112 case bfd_mach_mips5500: return AFL_EXT_5500;
14113 case bfd_mach_mips5900: return AFL_EXT_5900;
14114 case bfd_mach_mips10000: return AFL_EXT_10000;
14115 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e: return AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2E;
14116 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f: return AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2F;
14117 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a: return AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_3A;
14118 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1: return AFL_EXT_SB1;
14119 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon: return AFL_EXT_OCTEON;
14120 case bfd_mach_mips_octeonp: return AFL_EXT_OCTEONP;
14121 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon3: return AFL_EXT_OCTEON3;
14122 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon2: return AFL_EXT_OCTEON2;
14123 case bfd_mach_mips_xlr: return AFL_EXT_XLR;
14124 default: return 0;
14125 }
14126 }
14127
14128 /* Encode ISA level and revision as a single value. */
14129 #define LEVEL_REV(LEV,REV) ((LEV) << 3 | (REV))
14130
14131 /* Decode a single value into level and revision. */
14132 #define ISA_LEVEL(LEVREV) ((LEVREV) >> 3)
14133 #define ISA_REV(LEVREV) ((LEVREV) & 0x7)
14134
14135 /* Update the isa_level, isa_rev, isa_ext fields of abiflags. */
14136
14137 static void
14138 update_mips_abiflags_isa (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *abiflags)
14139 {
14140 int new_isa = 0;
14141 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
14142 {
14143 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (1, 0); break;
14144 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (2, 0); break;
14145 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (3, 0); break;
14146 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (4, 0); break;
14147 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (5, 0); break;
14148 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (32, 1); break;
14149 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (32, 2); break;
14150 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (32, 6); break;
14151 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (64, 1); break;
14152 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (64, 2); break;
14153 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (64, 6); break;
14154 default:
14155 _bfd_error_handler
14156 /* xgettext:c-format */
14157 (_("%B: Unknown architecture %s"),
14158 abfd, bfd_printable_name (abfd));
14159 }
14160
14161 if (new_isa > LEVEL_REV (abiflags->isa_level, abiflags->isa_rev))
14162 {
14163 abiflags->isa_level = ISA_LEVEL (new_isa);
14164 abiflags->isa_rev = ISA_REV (new_isa);
14165 }
14166
14167 /* Update the isa_ext if ABFD describes a further extension. */
14168 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (abiflags->isa_ext),
14169 bfd_get_mach (abfd)))
14170 abiflags->isa_ext = bfd_mips_isa_ext (abfd);
14171 }
14172
14173 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
14174
14175 static bfd_boolean
14176 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
14177 {
14178 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
14179 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
14180 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
14181 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
14182 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
14183 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
14184 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2
14185 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6);
14186 }
14187
14188 /* Infer the content of the ABI flags based on the elf header. */
14189
14190 static void
14191 infer_mips_abiflags (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0* abiflags)
14192 {
14193 obj_attribute *in_attr;
14194
14195 memset (abiflags, 0, sizeof (Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0));
14196 update_mips_abiflags_isa (abfd, abiflags);
14197
14198 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags))
14199 abiflags->gpr_size = AFL_REG_32;
14200 else
14201 abiflags->gpr_size = AFL_REG_64;
14202
14203 abiflags->cpr1_size = AFL_REG_NONE;
14204
14205 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (abfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
14206 abiflags->fp_abi = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
14207
14208 if (abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SINGLE
14209 || abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX
14210 || (abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
14211 && abiflags->gpr_size == AFL_REG_32))
14212 abiflags->cpr1_size = AFL_REG_32;
14213 else if (abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
14214 || abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
14215 || abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A)
14216 abiflags->cpr1_size = AFL_REG_64;
14217
14218 abiflags->cpr2_size = AFL_REG_NONE;
14219
14220 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
14221 abiflags->ases |= AFL_ASE_MDMX;
14222 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
14223 abiflags->ases |= AFL_ASE_MIPS16;
14224 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS)
14225 abiflags->ases |= AFL_ASE_MICROMIPS;
14226
14227 if (abiflags->fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY
14228 && abiflags->fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT
14229 && abiflags->fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A
14230 && abiflags->isa_level >= 32
14231 && abiflags->isa_ext != AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_3A)
14232 abiflags->flags1 |= AFL_FLAGS1_ODDSPREG;
14233 }
14234
14235 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
14236 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
14237 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
14238
14239 bfd_boolean
14240 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
14241 {
14242 asection *o;
14243 struct bfd_link_order *p;
14244 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
14245 asection *rtproc_sec, *abiflags_sec;
14246 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
14247 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
14248 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
14249 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
14250 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
14251 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
14252 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
14253 asection *s;
14254 EXTR esym;
14255 unsigned int i;
14256 bfd_size_type amt;
14257 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
14258
14259 static const char * const secname[] =
14260 {
14261 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
14262 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
14263 };
14264 static const int sc[] =
14265 {
14266 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
14267 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
14268 };
14269
14270 /* Sort the dynamic symbols so that those with GOT entries come after
14271 those without. */
14272 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
14273 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
14274
14275 if (!mips_elf_sort_hash_table (abfd, info))
14276 return FALSE;
14277
14278 /* Create any scheduled LA25 stubs. */
14279 hti.info = info;
14280 hti.output_bfd = abfd;
14281 hti.error = FALSE;
14282 htab_traverse (htab->la25_stubs, mips_elf_create_la25_stub, &hti);
14283 if (hti.error)
14284 return FALSE;
14285
14286 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
14287 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
14288 {
14289 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
14290
14291 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
14292 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
14293 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
14294 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
14295 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
14296 else if (htab->is_vxworks
14297 && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
14298 "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
14299 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
14300 && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
14301 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
14302 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
14303 + h->u.def.value);
14304 else if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
14305 {
14306 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
14307
14308 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
14309 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
14310 if (o->vma < lo
14311 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
14312 lo = o->vma;
14313
14314 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
14315 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
14316 }
14317 else
14318 {
14319 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
14320 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
14321 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
14322 }
14323 }
14324
14325 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
14326 information. */
14327 abiflags_sec = NULL;
14328 reginfo_sec = NULL;
14329 mdebug_sec = NULL;
14330 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
14331 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
14332 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
14333 {
14334 if (strcmp (o->name, ".MIPS.abiflags") == 0)
14335 {
14336 /* We have found the .MIPS.abiflags section in the output file.
14337 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and remove them.
14338 The data is merged in _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data. */
14339 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14340 {
14341 asection *input_section;
14342
14343 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14344 {
14345 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14346 continue;
14347 abort ();
14348 }
14349
14350 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14351
14352 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
14353 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
14354 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
14355 }
14356
14357 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
14358 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0));
14359
14360 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
14361 matters, but someday it might). */
14362 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
14363
14364 abiflags_sec = o;
14365 }
14366
14367 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
14368 {
14369 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
14370
14371 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
14372 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
14373 the information together. */
14374 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14375 {
14376 asection *input_section;
14377 bfd *input_bfd;
14378 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
14379 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
14380
14381 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14382 {
14383 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14384 continue;
14385 abort ();
14386 }
14387
14388 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14389 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
14390
14391 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
14392 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
14393 return FALSE;
14394
14395 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
14396
14397 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
14398 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
14399 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
14400 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
14401 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
14402
14403 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
14404 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
14405 finally written out. */
14406
14407 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
14408 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
14409 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
14410 }
14411
14412 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
14413 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
14414
14415 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
14416 matters, but someday it might). */
14417 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
14418
14419 reginfo_sec = o;
14420 }
14421
14422 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
14423 {
14424 struct extsym_info einfo;
14425 bfd_vma last;
14426
14427 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
14428 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
14429 the information together. */
14430 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
14431 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
14432 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
14433 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
14434 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
14435 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
14436 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
14437 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
14438 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
14439 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
14440 symhdr->issMax = 0;
14441 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
14442 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
14443 symhdr->crfd = 0;
14444 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
14445
14446 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
14447 debug_info structure. */
14448 debug.line = NULL;
14449 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
14450 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
14451 debug.external_sym = NULL;
14452 debug.external_opt = NULL;
14453 debug.external_aux = NULL;
14454 debug.ss = NULL;
14455 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
14456 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
14457 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
14458 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
14459
14460 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
14461 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
14462 return FALSE;
14463
14464 esym.jmptbl = 0;
14465 esym.cobol_main = 0;
14466 esym.weakext = 0;
14467 esym.reserved = 0;
14468 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
14469 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
14470 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
14471 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
14472 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
14473 last = 0;
14474 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
14475 {
14476 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
14477 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
14478 if (s != NULL)
14479 {
14480 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
14481 last = s->vma + s->size;
14482 }
14483 else
14484 esym.asym.value = last;
14485 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
14486 secname[i], &esym))
14487 return FALSE;
14488 }
14489
14490 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14491 {
14492 asection *input_section;
14493 bfd *input_bfd;
14494 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
14495 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
14496 char *eraw_src;
14497 char *eraw_end;
14498
14499 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14500 {
14501 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14502 continue;
14503 abort ();
14504 }
14505
14506 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14507 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
14508
14509 if (!is_mips_elf (input_bfd))
14510 {
14511 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
14512 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
14513 want to deal with it. */
14514 continue;
14515 }
14516
14517 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
14518 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
14519
14520 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
14521
14522 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
14523 read in the debugging information and set up an
14524 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
14525 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
14526 &input_debug))
14527 return FALSE;
14528
14529 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
14530 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
14531 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
14532 return FALSE;
14533
14534 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
14535 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
14536 the linker global hash table and save the information
14537 for the output external symbols. */
14538 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
14539 eraw_end = (eraw_src
14540 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
14541 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
14542 for (;
14543 eraw_src < eraw_end;
14544 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
14545 {
14546 EXTR ext;
14547 const char *name;
14548 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
14549
14550 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
14551 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
14552 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
14553 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
14554 continue;
14555
14556 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
14557 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
14558 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
14559 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
14560 continue;
14561
14562 if (ext.ifd != -1)
14563 {
14564 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
14565 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
14566 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
14567 }
14568
14569 h->esym = ext;
14570 }
14571
14572 /* Free up the information we just read. */
14573 free (input_debug.line);
14574 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
14575 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
14576 free (input_debug.external_sym);
14577 free (input_debug.external_opt);
14578 free (input_debug.external_aux);
14579 free (input_debug.ss);
14580 free (input_debug.ssext);
14581 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
14582 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
14583 free (input_debug.external_ext);
14584
14585 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
14586 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
14587 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
14588 }
14589
14590 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && bfd_link_pic (info))
14591 {
14592 /* Create .rtproc section. */
14593 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rtproc");
14594 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
14595 {
14596 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
14597 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
14598
14599 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd,
14600 ".rtproc",
14601 flags);
14602 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
14603 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
14604 return FALSE;
14605 }
14606
14607 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
14608 info, rtproc_sec,
14609 &debug))
14610 return FALSE;
14611 }
14612
14613 /* Build the external symbol information. */
14614 einfo.abfd = abfd;
14615 einfo.info = info;
14616 einfo.debug = &debug;
14617 einfo.swap = swap;
14618 einfo.failed = FALSE;
14619 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
14620 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
14621 if (einfo.failed)
14622 return FALSE;
14623
14624 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
14625 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
14626
14627 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
14628 matters, but someday it might). */
14629 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
14630
14631 mdebug_sec = o;
14632 }
14633
14634 if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
14635 {
14636 const char *subname;
14637 unsigned int c;
14638 Elf32_gptab *tab;
14639 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
14640 unsigned int j;
14641
14642 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
14643 information describing how the small data area would
14644 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
14645 not used in executables files. */
14646 if (! bfd_link_relocatable (info))
14647 {
14648 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14649 {
14650 asection *input_section;
14651
14652 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14653 {
14654 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14655 continue;
14656 abort ();
14657 }
14658
14659 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14660
14661 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
14662 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
14663 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
14664 }
14665
14666 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
14667 currently matters, but someday it might). */
14668 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
14669
14670 /* Really remove the section. */
14671 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
14672 --abfd->section_count;
14673
14674 continue;
14675 }
14676
14677 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
14678 uninitialized data. */
14679 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
14680 gptab_data_sec = o;
14681 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
14682 gptab_bss_sec = o;
14683 else
14684 {
14685 _bfd_error_handler
14686 /* xgettext:c-format */
14687 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
14688 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
14689 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
14690 return FALSE;
14691 }
14692
14693 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
14694 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
14695 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
14696 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
14697 case we must change the name of the output section. */
14698 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
14699 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
14700 {
14701 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
14702 o->name = ".gptab.data";
14703 else
14704 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
14705 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
14706 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
14707 }
14708
14709 /* Set up the first entry. */
14710 c = 1;
14711 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
14712 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
14713 if (tab == NULL)
14714 return FALSE;
14715 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
14716 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
14717
14718 /* Combine the input sections. */
14719 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14720 {
14721 asection *input_section;
14722 bfd *input_bfd;
14723 bfd_size_type size;
14724 unsigned long last;
14725 bfd_size_type gpentry;
14726
14727 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14728 {
14729 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14730 continue;
14731 abort ();
14732 }
14733
14734 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14735 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
14736
14737 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
14738 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
14739 sorted by ascending -G value. */
14740 size = input_section->size;
14741 last = 0;
14742 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
14743 gpentry < size;
14744 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
14745 {
14746 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
14747 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
14748 unsigned long val;
14749 unsigned long add;
14750 bfd_boolean exact;
14751 unsigned int look;
14752
14753 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
14754 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
14755 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
14756 {
14757 free (tab);
14758 return FALSE;
14759 }
14760
14761 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
14762 &int_gptab);
14763 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
14764 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
14765
14766 exact = FALSE;
14767 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
14768 {
14769 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
14770 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
14771
14772 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
14773 exact = TRUE;
14774 }
14775
14776 if (! exact)
14777 {
14778 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
14779 unsigned int max;
14780
14781 /* We need a new table entry. */
14782 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
14783 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
14784 if (new_tab == NULL)
14785 {
14786 free (tab);
14787 return FALSE;
14788 }
14789 tab = new_tab;
14790 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
14791 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
14792
14793 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
14794 value, since that will be implied by this new
14795 value. */
14796 max = 0;
14797 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
14798 {
14799 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
14800 && (max == 0
14801 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
14802 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
14803 max = look;
14804 }
14805 if (max != 0)
14806 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
14807 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
14808
14809 ++c;
14810 }
14811
14812 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
14813 }
14814
14815 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
14816 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
14817 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
14818 }
14819
14820 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
14821 if (c > 2)
14822 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
14823
14824 /* Swap out the table. */
14825 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
14826 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
14827 if (ext_tab == NULL)
14828 {
14829 free (tab);
14830 return FALSE;
14831 }
14832
14833 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
14834 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
14835 free (tab);
14836
14837 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
14838 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
14839
14840 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
14841 matters, but someday it might). */
14842 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
14843 }
14844 }
14845
14846 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
14847 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
14848 return FALSE;
14849
14850 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
14851
14852 if (abiflags_sec != NULL)
14853 {
14854 Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 ext;
14855 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *abiflags;
14856
14857 abiflags = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags;
14858
14859 /* Set up the abiflags if no valid input sections were found. */
14860 if (!mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid)
14861 {
14862 infer_mips_abiflags (abfd, abiflags);
14863 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
14864 }
14865 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_out (abfd, abiflags, &ext);
14866 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, abiflags_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
14867 return FALSE;
14868 }
14869
14870 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
14871 {
14872 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
14873
14874 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
14875 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
14876 return FALSE;
14877 }
14878
14879 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
14880 {
14881 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
14882 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
14883 swap, info,
14884 mdebug_sec->filepos))
14885 return FALSE;
14886
14887 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
14888 }
14889
14890 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
14891 {
14892 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
14893 gptab_data_sec->contents,
14894 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
14895 return FALSE;
14896 }
14897
14898 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
14899 {
14900 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
14901 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
14902 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
14903 return FALSE;
14904 }
14905
14906 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
14907 {
14908 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
14909 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
14910 {
14911 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
14912 rtproc_sec->contents,
14913 0, rtproc_sec->size))
14914 return FALSE;
14915 }
14916 }
14917
14918 return TRUE;
14919 }
14920 \f
14921 /* Merge object file header flags from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error
14922 if there are conflicting settings. */
14923
14924 static bfd_boolean
14925 mips_elf_merge_obj_e_flags (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
14926 {
14927 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
14928 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *out_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (obfd);
14929 flagword old_flags;
14930 flagword new_flags;
14931 bfd_boolean ok;
14932
14933 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
14934 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
14935 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
14936
14937 /* Check flag compatibility. */
14938
14939 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
14940 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
14941
14942 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
14943 doesn't seem to matter. */
14944 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
14945 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
14946
14947 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
14948 just be able to ignore this. */
14949 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
14950 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
14951
14952 /* DSOs should only be linked with CPIC code. */
14953 if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
14954 new_flags |= EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC;
14955
14956 if (new_flags == old_flags)
14957 return TRUE;
14958
14959 ok = TRUE;
14960
14961 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
14962 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
14963 {
14964 _bfd_error_handler
14965 (_("%B: warning: linking abicalls files with non-abicalls files"),
14966 ibfd);
14967 ok = TRUE;
14968 }
14969
14970 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
14971 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
14972 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
14973 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
14974
14975 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
14976 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
14977
14978 /* Compare the ISAs. */
14979 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
14980 {
14981 _bfd_error_handler
14982 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
14983 ibfd);
14984 ok = FALSE;
14985 }
14986 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
14987 {
14988 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
14989 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
14990 {
14991 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
14992 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
14993 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
14994 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
14995 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
14996 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
14997 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
14998
14999 /* Update the ABI flags isa_level, isa_rev, isa_ext fields. */
15000 update_mips_abiflags_isa (obfd, &out_tdata->abiflags);
15001
15002 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
15003 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
15004 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
15005 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
15006 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
15007 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
15008 }
15009 else
15010 {
15011 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
15012 _bfd_error_handler
15013 /* xgettext:c-format */
15014 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15015 ibfd,
15016 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
15017 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
15018 ok = FALSE;
15019 }
15020 }
15021
15022 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
15023 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
15024
15025 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
15026 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
15027 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
15028 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
15029 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
15030 {
15031 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
15032 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
15033 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
15034 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
15035 {
15036 _bfd_error_handler
15037 /* xgettext:c-format */
15038 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15039 ibfd,
15040 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
15041 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
15042 ok = FALSE;
15043 }
15044 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
15045 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
15046 }
15047
15048 /* Compare ASEs. Forbid linking MIPS16 and microMIPS ASE modules together
15049 and allow arbitrary mixing of the remaining ASEs (retain the union). */
15050 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
15051 {
15052 int old_micro = old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
15053 int new_micro = new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
15054 int old_m16 = old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
15055 int new_m16 = new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
15056 int micro_mis = old_m16 && new_micro;
15057 int m16_mis = old_micro && new_m16;
15058
15059 if (m16_mis || micro_mis)
15060 {
15061 _bfd_error_handler
15062 /* xgettext:c-format */
15063 (_("%B: ASE mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15064 ibfd,
15065 m16_mis ? "MIPS16" : "microMIPS",
15066 m16_mis ? "microMIPS" : "MIPS16");
15067 ok = FALSE;
15068 }
15069
15070 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
15071
15072 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
15073 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
15074 }
15075
15076 /* Compare NaN encodings. */
15077 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008))
15078 {
15079 /* xgettext:c-format */
15080 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15081 ibfd,
15082 (new_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008
15083 ? "-mnan=2008" : "-mnan=legacy"),
15084 (old_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008
15085 ? "-mnan=2008" : "-mnan=legacy"));
15086 ok = FALSE;
15087 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NAN2008;
15088 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NAN2008;
15089 }
15090
15091 /* Compare FP64 state. */
15092 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64))
15093 {
15094 /* xgettext:c-format */
15095 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15096 ibfd,
15097 (new_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64
15098 ? "-mfp64" : "-mfp32"),
15099 (old_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64
15100 ? "-mfp64" : "-mfp32"));
15101 ok = FALSE;
15102 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_FP64;
15103 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_FP64;
15104 }
15105
15106 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
15107 if (new_flags != old_flags)
15108 {
15109 /* xgettext:c-format */
15110 _bfd_error_handler
15111 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules "
15112 "(0x%lx)"),
15113 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
15114 (unsigned long) old_flags);
15115 ok = FALSE;
15116 }
15117
15118 return ok;
15119 }
15120
15121 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
15122 there are conflicting attributes. */
15123 static bfd_boolean
15124 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
15125 {
15126 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
15127 obj_attribute *in_attr;
15128 obj_attribute *out_attr;
15129 bfd *abi_fp_bfd;
15130 bfd *abi_msa_bfd;
15131
15132 abi_fp_bfd = mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd;
15133 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15134 if (!abi_fp_bfd && in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15135 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd = ibfd;
15136
15137 abi_msa_bfd = mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_msa_bfd;
15138 if (!abi_msa_bfd
15139 && in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_ANY)
15140 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_msa_bfd = ibfd;
15141
15142 if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
15143 {
15144 /* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
15145 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
15146
15147 /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
15148 initialized. */
15149 elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
15150
15151 return TRUE;
15152 }
15153
15154 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
15155 non-conflicting ones. */
15156 out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15157 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
15158 {
15159 int out_fp, in_fp;
15160
15161 out_fp = out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15162 in_fp = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15163 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
15164 if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15165 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_fp;
15166 else if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX
15167 && (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
15168 || in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
15169 || in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A))
15170 {
15171 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd = ibfd;
15172 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15173 }
15174 else if (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX
15175 && (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
15176 || out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
15177 || out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A))
15178 /* Keep the current setting. */;
15179 else if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A
15180 && in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64)
15181 {
15182 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd = ibfd;
15183 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15184 }
15185 else if (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A
15186 && out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64)
15187 /* Keep the current setting. */;
15188 else if (in_fp != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15189 {
15190 const char *out_string, *in_string;
15191
15192 out_string = _bfd_mips_fp_abi_string (out_fp);
15193 in_string = _bfd_mips_fp_abi_string (in_fp);
15194 /* First warn about cases involving unrecognised ABIs. */
15195 if (!out_string && !in_string)
15196 /* xgettext:c-format */
15197 _bfd_error_handler
15198 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
15199 "(set by %B), %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
15200 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, out_fp, in_fp);
15201 else if (!out_string)
15202 _bfd_error_handler
15203 /* xgettext:c-format */
15204 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
15205 "(set by %B), %B uses %s"),
15206 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, out_fp, in_string);
15207 else if (!in_string)
15208 _bfd_error_handler
15209 /* xgettext:c-format */
15210 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), "
15211 "%B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
15212 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, out_string, in_fp);
15213 else
15214 {
15215 /* If one of the bfds is soft-float, the other must be
15216 hard-float. The exact choice of hard-float ABI isn't
15217 really relevant to the error message. */
15218 if (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT)
15219 out_string = "-mhard-float";
15220 else if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT)
15221 in_string = "-mhard-float";
15222 _bfd_error_handler
15223 /* xgettext:c-format */
15224 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), %B uses %s"),
15225 obfd, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, out_string, in_string);
15226 }
15227 }
15228 }
15229
15230 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA attributes and merge
15231 non-conflicting ones. */
15232 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i)
15233 {
15234 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].type = 1;
15235 if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_ANY)
15236 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i;
15237 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_ANY)
15238 switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i)
15239 {
15240 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_128:
15241 _bfd_error_handler
15242 /* xgettext:c-format */
15243 (_("Warning: %B uses %s (set by %B), "
15244 "%B uses unknown MSA ABI %d"),
15245 obfd, abi_msa_bfd, ibfd,
15246 "-mmsa", in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i);
15247 break;
15248
15249 default:
15250 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i)
15251 {
15252 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_128:
15253 _bfd_error_handler
15254 /* xgettext:c-format */
15255 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown MSA ABI %d "
15256 "(set by %B), %B uses %s"),
15257 obfd, abi_msa_bfd, ibfd,
15258 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i, "-mmsa");
15259 break;
15260
15261 default:
15262 _bfd_error_handler
15263 /* xgettext:c-format */
15264 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown MSA ABI %d "
15265 "(set by %B), %B uses unknown MSA ABI %d"),
15266 obfd, abi_msa_bfd, ibfd,
15267 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i,
15268 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i);
15269 break;
15270 }
15271 }
15272 }
15273
15274 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
15275 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
15276 }
15277
15278 /* Merge object ABI flags from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
15279 there are conflicting settings. */
15280
15281 static bfd_boolean
15282 mips_elf_merge_obj_abiflags (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
15283 {
15284 obj_attribute *out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15285 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *out_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (obfd);
15286 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *in_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (ibfd);
15287
15288 /* Update the output abiflags fp_abi using the computed fp_abi. */
15289 out_tdata->abiflags.fp_abi = out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15290
15291 #define max(a, b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b))
15292 /* Merge abiflags. */
15293 out_tdata->abiflags.isa_level = max (out_tdata->abiflags.isa_level,
15294 in_tdata->abiflags.isa_level);
15295 out_tdata->abiflags.isa_rev = max (out_tdata->abiflags.isa_rev,
15296 in_tdata->abiflags.isa_rev);
15297 out_tdata->abiflags.gpr_size = max (out_tdata->abiflags.gpr_size,
15298 in_tdata->abiflags.gpr_size);
15299 out_tdata->abiflags.cpr1_size = max (out_tdata->abiflags.cpr1_size,
15300 in_tdata->abiflags.cpr1_size);
15301 out_tdata->abiflags.cpr2_size = max (out_tdata->abiflags.cpr2_size,
15302 in_tdata->abiflags.cpr2_size);
15303 #undef max
15304 out_tdata->abiflags.ases |= in_tdata->abiflags.ases;
15305 out_tdata->abiflags.flags1 |= in_tdata->abiflags.flags1;
15306
15307 return TRUE;
15308 }
15309
15310 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
15311 object file when linking. */
15312
15313 bfd_boolean
15314 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
15315 {
15316 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
15317 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *out_tdata;
15318 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *in_tdata;
15319 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
15320 asection *sec;
15321 bfd_boolean ok;
15322
15323 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
15324 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
15325 {
15326 _bfd_error_handler
15327 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
15328 ibfd);
15329 return FALSE;
15330 }
15331
15332 if (!is_mips_elf (ibfd) || !is_mips_elf (obfd))
15333 return TRUE;
15334
15335 in_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (ibfd);
15336 out_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (obfd);
15337
15338 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
15339 {
15340 _bfd_error_handler
15341 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
15342 ibfd);
15343 return FALSE;
15344 }
15345
15346 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections. If not,
15347 then it has no attributes, and its flags may not have been initialized
15348 either, but it cannot actually cause any incompatibility. */
15349 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
15350 {
15351 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
15352 which are automatically generated by gas. Also ignore fake
15353 (s)common sections, since merely defining a common symbol does
15354 not affect compatibility. */
15355 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IS_COMMON) == 0
15356 && strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
15357 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
15358 && (sec->size != 0
15359 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
15360 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
15361 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
15362 {
15363 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
15364 break;
15365 }
15366 }
15367 if (null_input_bfd)
15368 return TRUE;
15369
15370 /* Populate abiflags using existing information. */
15371 if (in_tdata->abiflags_valid)
15372 {
15373 obj_attribute *in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15374 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 in_abiflags;
15375 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 abiflags;
15376
15377 /* Set up the FP ABI attribute from the abiflags if it is not already
15378 set. */
15379 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15380 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_tdata->abiflags.fp_abi;
15381
15382 infer_mips_abiflags (ibfd, &abiflags);
15383 in_abiflags = in_tdata->abiflags;
15384
15385 /* It is not possible to infer the correct ISA revision
15386 for R3 or R5 so drop down to R2 for the checks. */
15387 if (in_abiflags.isa_rev == 3 || in_abiflags.isa_rev == 5)
15388 in_abiflags.isa_rev = 2;
15389
15390 if (LEVEL_REV (in_abiflags.isa_level, in_abiflags.isa_rev)
15391 < LEVEL_REV (abiflags.isa_level, abiflags.isa_rev))
15392 _bfd_error_handler
15393 (_("%B: warning: Inconsistent ISA between e_flags and "
15394 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15395 if (abiflags.fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY
15396 && in_abiflags.fp_abi != abiflags.fp_abi)
15397 _bfd_error_handler
15398 (_("%B: warning: Inconsistent FP ABI between .gnu.attributes and "
15399 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15400 if ((in_abiflags.ases & abiflags.ases) != abiflags.ases)
15401 _bfd_error_handler
15402 (_("%B: warning: Inconsistent ASEs between e_flags and "
15403 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15404 /* The isa_ext is allowed to be an extension of what can be inferred
15405 from e_flags. */
15406 if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (abiflags.isa_ext),
15407 bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (in_abiflags.isa_ext)))
15408 _bfd_error_handler
15409 (_("%B: warning: Inconsistent ISA extensions between e_flags and "
15410 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15411 if (in_abiflags.flags2 != 0)
15412 _bfd_error_handler
15413 (_("%B: warning: Unexpected flag in the flags2 field of "
15414 ".MIPS.abiflags (0x%lx)"), ibfd,
15415 (unsigned long) in_abiflags.flags2);
15416 }
15417 else
15418 {
15419 infer_mips_abiflags (ibfd, &in_tdata->abiflags);
15420 in_tdata->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
15421 }
15422
15423 if (!out_tdata->abiflags_valid)
15424 {
15425 /* Copy input abiflags if output abiflags are not already valid. */
15426 out_tdata->abiflags = in_tdata->abiflags;
15427 out_tdata->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
15428 }
15429
15430 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
15431 {
15432 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
15433 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
15434 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
15435 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
15436
15437 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
15438 && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
15439 || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
15440 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
15441 {
15442 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
15443 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
15444 return FALSE;
15445
15446 /* Update the ABI flags isa_level, isa_rev and isa_ext fields. */
15447 update_mips_abiflags_isa (obfd, &out_tdata->abiflags);
15448 }
15449
15450 ok = TRUE;
15451 }
15452 else
15453 ok = mips_elf_merge_obj_e_flags (ibfd, info);
15454
15455 ok = mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info) && ok;
15456
15457 ok = mips_elf_merge_obj_abiflags (ibfd, obfd) && ok;
15458
15459 if (!ok)
15460 {
15461 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15462 return FALSE;
15463 }
15464
15465 return TRUE;
15466 }
15467
15468 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
15469
15470 bfd_boolean
15471 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
15472 {
15473 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
15474 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
15475
15476 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
15477 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
15478 return TRUE;
15479 }
15480
15481 char *
15482 _bfd_mips_elf_get_target_dtag (bfd_vma dtag)
15483 {
15484 switch (dtag)
15485 {
15486 default: return "";
15487 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
15488 return "MIPS_RLD_VERSION";
15489 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
15490 return "MIPS_TIME_STAMP";
15491 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
15492 return "MIPS_ICHECKSUM";
15493 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
15494 return "MIPS_IVERSION";
15495 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
15496 return "MIPS_FLAGS";
15497 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
15498 return "MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS";
15499 case DT_MIPS_MSYM:
15500 return "MIPS_MSYM";
15501 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
15502 return "MIPS_CONFLICT";
15503 case DT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
15504 return "MIPS_LIBLIST";
15505 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
15506 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO";
15507 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICTNO:
15508 return "MIPS_CONFLICTNO";
15509 case DT_MIPS_LIBLISTNO:
15510 return "MIPS_LIBLISTNO";
15511 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
15512 return "MIPS_SYMTABNO";
15513 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
15514 return "MIPS_UNREFEXTNO";
15515 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
15516 return "MIPS_GOTSYM";
15517 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
15518 return "MIPS_HIPAGENO";
15519 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
15520 return "MIPS_RLD_MAP";
15521 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL:
15522 return "MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL";
15523 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS:
15524 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS";
15525 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO:
15526 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO";
15527 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE:
15528 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE";
15529 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO:
15530 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO";
15531 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC:
15532 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC";
15533 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO:
15534 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO";
15535 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM:
15536 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM";
15537 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO:
15538 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO";
15539 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM:
15540 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM";
15541 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO:
15542 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO";
15543 case DT_MIPS_CXX_FLAGS:
15544 return "MIPS_CXX_FLAGS";
15545 case DT_MIPS_PIXIE_INIT:
15546 return "MIPS_PIXIE_INIT";
15547 case DT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
15548 return "MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB";
15549 case DT_MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX:
15550 return "MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX";
15551 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX:
15552 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX";
15553 case DT_MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX:
15554 return "MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX";
15555 case DT_MIPS_PROTECTED_GOTIDX:
15556 return "MIPS_PROTECTED_GOT_IDX";
15557 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
15558 return "MIPS_OPTIONS";
15559 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE:
15560 return "MIPS_INTERFACE";
15561 case DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN:
15562 return "DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN";
15563 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE:
15564 return "DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE";
15565 case DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR:
15566 return "DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR";
15567 case DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX:
15568 return "DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX";
15569 case DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE:
15570 return "DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE";
15571 case DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE:
15572 return "DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE";
15573 case DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC:
15574 return "DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC";
15575 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
15576 return "DT_MIPS_PLTGOT";
15577 case DT_MIPS_RWPLT:
15578 return "DT_MIPS_RWPLT";
15579 }
15580 }
15581
15582 /* Return the meaning of Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP value FP, or null if
15583 not known. */
15584
15585 const char *
15586 _bfd_mips_fp_abi_string (int fp)
15587 {
15588 switch (fp)
15589 {
15590 /* These strings aren't translated because they're simply
15591 option lists. */
15592 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE:
15593 return "-mdouble-float";
15594
15595 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SINGLE:
15596 return "-msingle-float";
15597
15598 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT:
15599 return "-msoft-float";
15600
15601 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_OLD_64:
15602 return _("-mips32r2 -mfp64 (12 callee-saved)");
15603
15604 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX:
15605 return "-mfpxx";
15606
15607 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64:
15608 return "-mgp32 -mfp64";
15609
15610 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A:
15611 return "-mgp32 -mfp64 -mno-odd-spreg";
15612
15613 default:
15614 return 0;
15615 }
15616 }
15617
15618 static void
15619 print_mips_ases (FILE *file, unsigned int mask)
15620 {
15621 if (mask & AFL_ASE_DSP)
15622 fputs ("\n\tDSP ASE", file);
15623 if (mask & AFL_ASE_DSPR2)
15624 fputs ("\n\tDSP R2 ASE", file);
15625 if (mask & AFL_ASE_DSPR3)
15626 fputs ("\n\tDSP R3 ASE", file);
15627 if (mask & AFL_ASE_EVA)
15628 fputs ("\n\tEnhanced VA Scheme", file);
15629 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MCU)
15630 fputs ("\n\tMCU (MicroController) ASE", file);
15631 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MDMX)
15632 fputs ("\n\tMDMX ASE", file);
15633 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MIPS3D)
15634 fputs ("\n\tMIPS-3D ASE", file);
15635 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MT)
15636 fputs ("\n\tMT ASE", file);
15637 if (mask & AFL_ASE_SMARTMIPS)
15638 fputs ("\n\tSmartMIPS ASE", file);
15639 if (mask & AFL_ASE_VIRT)
15640 fputs ("\n\tVZ ASE", file);
15641 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MSA)
15642 fputs ("\n\tMSA ASE", file);
15643 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MIPS16)
15644 fputs ("\n\tMIPS16 ASE", file);
15645 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MICROMIPS)
15646 fputs ("\n\tMICROMIPS ASE", file);
15647 if (mask & AFL_ASE_XPA)
15648 fputs ("\n\tXPA ASE", file);
15649 if (mask == 0)
15650 fprintf (file, "\n\t%s", _("None"));
15651 else if ((mask & ~AFL_ASE_MASK) != 0)
15652 fprintf (stdout, "\n\t%s (%x)", _("Unknown"), mask & ~AFL_ASE_MASK);
15653 }
15654
15655 static void
15656 print_mips_isa_ext (FILE *file, unsigned int isa_ext)
15657 {
15658 switch (isa_ext)
15659 {
15660 case 0:
15661 fputs (_("None"), file);
15662 break;
15663 case AFL_EXT_XLR:
15664 fputs ("RMI XLR", file);
15665 break;
15666 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON3:
15667 fputs ("Cavium Networks Octeon3", file);
15668 break;
15669 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON2:
15670 fputs ("Cavium Networks Octeon2", file);
15671 break;
15672 case AFL_EXT_OCTEONP:
15673 fputs ("Cavium Networks OcteonP", file);
15674 break;
15675 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_3A:
15676 fputs ("Loongson 3A", file);
15677 break;
15678 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON:
15679 fputs ("Cavium Networks Octeon", file);
15680 break;
15681 case AFL_EXT_5900:
15682 fputs ("Toshiba R5900", file);
15683 break;
15684 case AFL_EXT_4650:
15685 fputs ("MIPS R4650", file);
15686 break;
15687 case AFL_EXT_4010:
15688 fputs ("LSI R4010", file);
15689 break;
15690 case AFL_EXT_4100:
15691 fputs ("NEC VR4100", file);
15692 break;
15693 case AFL_EXT_3900:
15694 fputs ("Toshiba R3900", file);
15695 break;
15696 case AFL_EXT_10000:
15697 fputs ("MIPS R10000", file);
15698 break;
15699 case AFL_EXT_SB1:
15700 fputs ("Broadcom SB-1", file);
15701 break;
15702 case AFL_EXT_4111:
15703 fputs ("NEC VR4111/VR4181", file);
15704 break;
15705 case AFL_EXT_4120:
15706 fputs ("NEC VR4120", file);
15707 break;
15708 case AFL_EXT_5400:
15709 fputs ("NEC VR5400", file);
15710 break;
15711 case AFL_EXT_5500:
15712 fputs ("NEC VR5500", file);
15713 break;
15714 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2E:
15715 fputs ("ST Microelectronics Loongson 2E", file);
15716 break;
15717 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2F:
15718 fputs ("ST Microelectronics Loongson 2F", file);
15719 break;
15720 default:
15721 fprintf (file, "%s (%d)", _("Unknown"), isa_ext);
15722 break;
15723 }
15724 }
15725
15726 static void
15727 print_mips_fp_abi_value (FILE *file, int val)
15728 {
15729 switch (val)
15730 {
15731 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY:
15732 fprintf (file, _("Hard or soft float\n"));
15733 break;
15734 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE:
15735 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (double precision)\n"));
15736 break;
15737 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SINGLE:
15738 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (single precision)\n"));
15739 break;
15740 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT:
15741 fprintf (file, _("Soft float\n"));
15742 break;
15743 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_OLD_64:
15744 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (MIPS32r2 64-bit FPU 12 callee-saved)\n"));
15745 break;
15746 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX:
15747 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (32-bit CPU, Any FPU)\n"));
15748 break;
15749 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64:
15750 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (32-bit CPU, 64-bit FPU)\n"));
15751 break;
15752 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A:
15753 fprintf (file, _("Hard float compat (32-bit CPU, 64-bit FPU)\n"));
15754 break;
15755 default:
15756 fprintf (file, "??? (%d)\n", val);
15757 break;
15758 }
15759 }
15760
15761 static int
15762 get_mips_reg_size (int reg_size)
15763 {
15764 return (reg_size == AFL_REG_NONE) ? 0
15765 : (reg_size == AFL_REG_32) ? 32
15766 : (reg_size == AFL_REG_64) ? 64
15767 : (reg_size == AFL_REG_128) ? 128
15768 : -1;
15769 }
15770
15771 bfd_boolean
15772 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
15773 {
15774 FILE *file = ptr;
15775
15776 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
15777
15778 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
15779 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
15780
15781 /* xgettext:c-format */
15782 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
15783
15784 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
15785 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
15786 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
15787 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
15788 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
15789 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
15790 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
15791 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
15792 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
15793 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
15794 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
15795 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
15796 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
15797 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
15798 else
15799 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
15800
15801 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
15802 fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
15803 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
15804 fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
15805 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
15806 fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
15807 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
15808 fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
15809 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
15810 fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
15811 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
15812 fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
15813 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
15814 fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
15815 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
15816 fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
15817 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
15818 fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
15819 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6)
15820 fprintf (file, " [mips32r6]");
15821 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6)
15822 fprintf (file, " [mips64r6]");
15823 else
15824 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
15825
15826 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
15827 fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
15828
15829 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
15830 fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
15831
15832 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS)
15833 fprintf (file, " [micromips]");
15834
15835 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008)
15836 fprintf (file, " [nan2008]");
15837
15838 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64)
15839 fprintf (file, " [old fp64]");
15840
15841 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
15842 fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
15843 else
15844 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
15845
15846 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
15847 fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
15848
15849 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
15850 fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
15851
15852 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
15853 fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
15854
15855 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
15856 fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
15857
15858 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
15859 fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
15860
15861 fputc ('\n', file);
15862
15863 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid)
15864 {
15865 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *abiflags = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags;
15866 fprintf (file, "\nMIPS ABI Flags Version: %d\n", abiflags->version);
15867 fprintf (file, "\nISA: MIPS%d", abiflags->isa_level);
15868 if (abiflags->isa_rev > 1)
15869 fprintf (file, "r%d", abiflags->isa_rev);
15870 fprintf (file, "\nGPR size: %d",
15871 get_mips_reg_size (abiflags->gpr_size));
15872 fprintf (file, "\nCPR1 size: %d",
15873 get_mips_reg_size (abiflags->cpr1_size));
15874 fprintf (file, "\nCPR2 size: %d",
15875 get_mips_reg_size (abiflags->cpr2_size));
15876 fputs ("\nFP ABI: ", file);
15877 print_mips_fp_abi_value (file, abiflags->fp_abi);
15878 fputs ("ISA Extension: ", file);
15879 print_mips_isa_ext (file, abiflags->isa_ext);
15880 fputs ("\nASEs:", file);
15881 print_mips_ases (file, abiflags->ases);
15882 fprintf (file, "\nFLAGS 1: %8.8lx", abiflags->flags1);
15883 fprintf (file, "\nFLAGS 2: %8.8lx", abiflags->flags2);
15884 fputc ('\n', file);
15885 }
15886
15887 return TRUE;
15888 }
15889
15890 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
15891 {
15892 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
15893 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
15894 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
15895 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
15896 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
15897 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"), 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
15898 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
15899 };
15900
15901 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes. Ensure that the
15902 STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
15903 definiton of the symbol. */
15904 void
15905 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
15906 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
15907 bfd_boolean definition,
15908 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15909 {
15910 if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
15911 {
15912 unsigned char other;
15913
15914 other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
15915 other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
15916 h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
15917 }
15918
15919 if (!definition
15920 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
15921 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
15922 }
15923
15924 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
15925 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
15926 bfd_boolean
15927 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
15928 {
15929 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
15930 }
15931
15932 bfd_boolean
15933 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
15934 {
15935 return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
15936 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
15937 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
15938 }
15939
15940 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
15941 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
15942
15943 bfd_vma
15944 _bfd_mips_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i, const asection *plt,
15945 const arelent *rel ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15946 {
15947 return (plt->vma
15948 + 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
15949 + i * 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry));
15950 }
15951
15952 /* Build a table of synthetic symbols to represent the PLT. As with MIPS16
15953 and microMIPS PLT slots we may have a many-to-one mapping between .plt
15954 and .got.plt and also the slots may be of a different size each we walk
15955 the PLT manually fetching instructions and matching them against known
15956 patterns. To make things easier standard MIPS slots, if any, always come
15957 first. As we don't create proper ELF symbols we use the UDATA.I member
15958 of ASYMBOL to carry ISA annotation. The encoding used is the same as
15959 with the ST_OTHER member of the ELF symbol. */
15960
15961 long
15962 _bfd_mips_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
15963 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
15964 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
15965 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
15966 asymbol **ret)
15967 {
15968 static const char pltname[] = "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_";
15969 static const char microsuffix[] = "@micromipsplt";
15970 static const char m16suffix[] = "@mips16plt";
15971 static const char mipssuffix[] = "@plt";
15972
15973 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
15974 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
15975 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (abfd);
15976 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
15977 bfd_byte *plt_data;
15978 bfd_vma plt_offset;
15979 unsigned int other;
15980 bfd_vma entry_size;
15981 bfd_vma plt0_size;
15982 asection *relplt;
15983 bfd_vma opcode;
15984 asection *plt;
15985 asymbol *send;
15986 size_t size;
15987 char *names;
15988 long counti;
15989 arelent *p;
15990 asymbol *s;
15991 char *nend;
15992 long count;
15993 long pi;
15994 long i;
15995 long n;
15996
15997 *ret = NULL;
15998
15999 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0 || dynsymcount <= 0)
16000 return 0;
16001
16002 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rel.plt");
16003 if (relplt == NULL)
16004 return 0;
16005
16006 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
16007 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd) || hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
16008 return 0;
16009
16010 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
16011 if (plt == NULL)
16012 return 0;
16013
16014 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
16015 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
16016 return -1;
16017 p = relplt->relocation;
16018
16019 /* Calculating the exact amount of space required for symbols would
16020 require two passes over the PLT, so just pessimise assuming two
16021 PLT slots per relocation. */
16022 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
16023 counti = count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
16024 size = 2 * count * sizeof (asymbol);
16025 size += count * (sizeof (mipssuffix) +
16026 (micromips_p ? sizeof (microsuffix) : sizeof (m16suffix)));
16027 for (pi = 0; pi < counti; pi += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
16028 size += 2 * strlen ((*p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
16029
16030 /* Add the size of "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_" too. */
16031 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof (pltname);
16032
16033 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, plt, &plt_data))
16034 return -1;
16035
16036 if (plt->size < 16)
16037 return -1;
16038
16039 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
16040 if (s == NULL)
16041 return -1;
16042 send = s + 2 * count + 1;
16043
16044 names = (char *) send;
16045 nend = (char *) s + size;
16046 n = 0;
16047
16048 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, plt_data + 12);
16049 if (opcode == 0x3302fffe)
16050 {
16051 if (!micromips_p)
16052 return -1;
16053 plt0_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
16054 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16055 }
16056 else if (opcode == 0x0398c1d0)
16057 {
16058 if (!micromips_p)
16059 return -1;
16060 plt0_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
16061 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16062 }
16063 else
16064 {
16065 plt0_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
16066 other = 0;
16067 }
16068
16069 s->the_bfd = abfd;
16070 s->flags = BSF_SYNTHETIC | BSF_FUNCTION | BSF_LOCAL;
16071 s->section = plt;
16072 s->value = 0;
16073 s->name = names;
16074 s->udata.i = other;
16075 memcpy (names, pltname, sizeof (pltname));
16076 names += sizeof (pltname);
16077 ++s, ++n;
16078
16079 pi = 0;
16080 for (plt_offset = plt0_size;
16081 plt_offset + 8 <= plt->size && s < send;
16082 plt_offset += entry_size)
16083 {
16084 bfd_vma gotplt_addr;
16085 const char *suffix;
16086 bfd_vma gotplt_hi;
16087 bfd_vma gotplt_lo;
16088 size_t suffixlen;
16089
16090 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 4);
16091
16092 /* Check if the second word matches the expected MIPS16 instruction. */
16093 if (opcode == 0x651aeb00)
16094 {
16095 if (micromips_p)
16096 return -1;
16097 /* Truncated table??? */
16098 if (plt_offset + 16 > plt->size)
16099 break;
16100 gotplt_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 12);
16101 entry_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry);
16102 suffixlen = sizeof (m16suffix);
16103 suffix = m16suffix;
16104 other = STO_MIPS16;
16105 }
16106 /* Likewise the expected microMIPS instruction (no insn32 mode). */
16107 else if (opcode == 0xff220000)
16108 {
16109 if (!micromips_p)
16110 return -1;
16111 gotplt_hi = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset) & 0x7f;
16112 gotplt_lo = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 2) & 0xffff;
16113 gotplt_hi = ((gotplt_hi ^ 0x40) - 0x40) << 18;
16114 gotplt_lo <<= 2;
16115 gotplt_addr = gotplt_hi + gotplt_lo;
16116 gotplt_addr += ((plt->vma + plt_offset) | 3) ^ 3;
16117 entry_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry);
16118 suffixlen = sizeof (microsuffix);
16119 suffix = microsuffix;
16120 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16121 }
16122 /* Likewise the expected microMIPS instruction (insn32 mode). */
16123 else if ((opcode & 0xffff0000) == 0xff2f0000)
16124 {
16125 gotplt_hi = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 2) & 0xffff;
16126 gotplt_lo = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 6) & 0xffff;
16127 gotplt_hi = ((gotplt_hi ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000) << 16;
16128 gotplt_lo = (gotplt_lo ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
16129 gotplt_addr = gotplt_hi + gotplt_lo;
16130 entry_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry);
16131 suffixlen = sizeof (microsuffix);
16132 suffix = microsuffix;
16133 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16134 }
16135 /* Otherwise assume standard MIPS code. */
16136 else
16137 {
16138 gotplt_hi = bfd_get_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset) & 0xffff;
16139 gotplt_lo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 4) & 0xffff;
16140 gotplt_hi = ((gotplt_hi ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000) << 16;
16141 gotplt_lo = (gotplt_lo ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
16142 gotplt_addr = gotplt_hi + gotplt_lo;
16143 entry_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
16144 suffixlen = sizeof (mipssuffix);
16145 suffix = mipssuffix;
16146 other = 0;
16147 }
16148 /* Truncated table??? */
16149 if (plt_offset + entry_size > plt->size)
16150 break;
16151
16152 for (i = 0;
16153 i < count && p[pi].address != gotplt_addr;
16154 i++, pi = (pi + bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel) % counti);
16155
16156 if (i < count)
16157 {
16158 size_t namelen;
16159 size_t len;
16160
16161 *s = **p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr;
16162 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
16163 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
16164 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
16165 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
16166 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
16167 s->section = plt;
16168 s->value = plt_offset;
16169 s->name = names;
16170 s->udata.i = other;
16171
16172 len = strlen ((*p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
16173 namelen = len + suffixlen;
16174 if (names + namelen > nend)
16175 break;
16176
16177 memcpy (names, (*p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
16178 names += len;
16179 memcpy (names, suffix, suffixlen);
16180 names += suffixlen;
16181
16182 ++s, ++n;
16183 pi = (pi + bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel) % counti;
16184 }
16185 }
16186
16187 free (plt_data);
16188
16189 return n;
16190 }
16191
16192 /* Return the ABI flags associated with ABFD if available. */
16193
16194 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *
16195 bfd_mips_elf_get_abiflags (bfd *abfd)
16196 {
16197 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *tdata = mips_elf_tdata (abfd);
16198
16199 return tdata->abiflags_valid ? &tdata->abiflags : NULL;
16200 }
16201
16202 void
16203 _bfd_mips_post_process_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
16204 {
16205 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
16206 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
16207
16208 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
16209 if (link_info)
16210 {
16211 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (link_info);
16212 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
16213
16214 if (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs && !htab->is_vxworks)
16215 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = 1;
16216 }
16217
16218 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (abfd, link_info);
16219
16220 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags.fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
16221 || mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags.fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A)
16222 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = 3;
16223 }
16224
16225 int
16226 _bfd_mips_elf_compact_eh_encoding (struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16227 {
16228 return DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4;
16229 }
16230
16231 /* Return the opcode for can't unwind. */
16232
16233 int
16234 _bfd_mips_elf_cant_unwind_opcode (struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16235 {
16236 return COMPACT_EH_CANT_UNWIND_OPCODE;
16237 }
This page took 0.565797 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.